Mercurial > emacs
annotate src/gtkutil.c @ 111866:dc4c9e6071a2
* lisp/files.el (diff-no-select): Declare.
author | Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org> |
---|---|
date | Thu, 09 Dec 2010 19:47:49 -0800 |
parents | 0bd93f14fcb6 |
children | 968255ee954a |
rev | line source |
---|---|
49323 | 1 /* Functions for creating and updating GTK widgets. |
106815 | 2 Copyright (C) 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 |
79759 | 3 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
49323 | 4 |
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs. | |
6 | |
94963
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
93427
diff
changeset
|
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify |
49323 | 8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by |
94963
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
93427
diff
changeset
|
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or |
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
93427
diff
changeset
|
10 (at your option) any later version. |
49323 | 11 |
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, | |
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of | |
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the | |
15 GNU General Public License for more details. | |
16 | |
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License | |
94963
8971ddf55736
Switch to recommended form of GPLv3 permissions notice.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
93427
diff
changeset
|
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */ |
49323 | 19 |
80608
83a48972e1ea
Include <config.h> instead of "config.h".
YAMAMOTO Mitsuharu <mituharu@math.s.chiba-u.ac.jp>
parents:
79759
diff
changeset
|
20 #include <config.h> |
49323 | 21 |
22 #ifdef USE_GTK | |
58818
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
23 #include <signal.h> |
49359
14cf50ecf91a
gtkutil.c: Must include stdio.h before termhooks.h
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49325
diff
changeset
|
24 #include <stdio.h> |
105669
68dd71358159
* alloc.c: Do not define struct catchtag.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
105522
diff
changeset
|
25 #include <setjmp.h> |
49323 | 26 #include "lisp.h" |
27 #include "xterm.h" | |
28 #include "blockinput.h" | |
58818
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
29 #include "syssignal.h" |
49323 | 30 #include "window.h" |
31 #include "gtkutil.h" | |
32 #include "termhooks.h" | |
51408
8f1bed1dee3c
Include keyboard.h, charset.h, coding.h.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
51211
diff
changeset
|
33 #include "keyboard.h" |
8f1bed1dee3c
Include keyboard.h, charset.h, coding.h.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
51211
diff
changeset
|
34 #include "charset.h" |
8f1bed1dee3c
Include keyboard.h, charset.h, coding.h.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
51211
diff
changeset
|
35 #include "coding.h" |
49323 | 36 #include <gdk/gdkkeysyms.h> |
108082
38a6893c8b9e
* gtkutil.c: Include xsettings.h for Ftool_bar_get_system_style.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
108024
diff
changeset
|
37 #include "xsettings.h" |
49323 | 38 |
97059
984f2ac5a637
* lisp.h (init_weak_hash_tables, syms_of_font)
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
97056
diff
changeset
|
39 #ifdef HAVE_XFT |
984f2ac5a637
* lisp.h (init_weak_hash_tables, syms_of_font)
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
97056
diff
changeset
|
40 #include <X11/Xft/Xft.h> |
984f2ac5a637
* lisp.h (init_weak_hash_tables, syms_of_font)
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
97056
diff
changeset
|
41 #endif |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
42 |
49323 | 43 #define FRAME_TOTAL_PIXEL_HEIGHT(f) \ |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
44 (FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f)) |
50129
d0142038feaa
Reduce flicker in GTK scrollbars.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50112
diff
changeset
|
45 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
46 #define FRAME_TOTAL_PIXEL_WIDTH(f) \ |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
47 (FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
48 |
67528
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
49 /* Avoid "differ in sign" warnings */ |
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
50 #define SSDATA(x) ((char *) SDATA (x)) |
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
51 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
52 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_WIDGET_SET_HAS_WINDOW |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
53 #define gtk_widget_set_has_window(w, b) \ |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
54 (gtk_fixed_set_has_window (GTK_FIXED (w), b)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
55 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
56 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_DIALOG_GET_ACTION_AREA |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
57 #define gtk_dialog_get_action_area(w) ((w)->action_area) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
58 #define gtk_dialog_get_content_area(w) ((w)->vbox) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
59 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
60 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_WIDGET_GET_SENSITIVE |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
61 #define gtk_widget_get_sensitive(w) (GTK_WIDGET_SENSITIVE (w)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
62 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
63 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_ADJUSTMENT_GET_PAGE_SIZE |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
64 #define gtk_adjustment_set_page_size(w, s) ((w)->page_size = (s)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
65 #define gtk_adjustment_set_page_increment(w, s) ((w)->page_increment = (s)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
66 #define gtk_adjustment_get_step_increment(w) ((w)->step_increment) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
67 #define gtk_adjustment_set_step_increment(w, s) ((w)->step_increment = (s)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
68 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
69 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION > 2 || GTK_MINOR_VERSION > 11 |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
70 #define remove_submenu(w) gtk_menu_item_set_submenu ((w), NULL) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
71 #else |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
72 #define remove_submenu(w) gtk_menu_item_remove_submenu ((w)) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
73 #endif |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
74 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
75 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
76 /*********************************************************************** |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
77 Display handling functions |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
78 ***********************************************************************/ |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
79 |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
80 /* Keep track of the default display, or NULL if there is none. Emacs |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
81 may close all its displays. */ |
84621 | 82 |
83 static GdkDisplay *gdpy_def; | |
84 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
85 /* When the GTK widget W is to be created on a display for F that |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
86 is not the default display, set the display for W. |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
87 W can be a GtkMenu or a GtkWindow widget. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
88 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
89 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
90 xg_set_screen (GtkWidget *w, FRAME_PTR f) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
91 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
92 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f) != GDK_DISPLAY ()) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
93 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
94 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
95 GdkScreen *gscreen = gdk_display_get_default_screen (gdpy); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
96 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
97 if (GTK_IS_MENU (w)) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
98 gtk_menu_set_screen (GTK_MENU (w), gscreen); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
99 else |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
100 gtk_window_set_screen (GTK_WINDOW (w), gscreen); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
101 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
102 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
103 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
104 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
105 /* Open a display named by DISPLAY_NAME. The display is returned in *DPY. |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
106 *DPY is set to NULL if the display can't be opened. |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
107 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
108 Returns non-zero if display could be opened, zero if display could not |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
109 be opened, and less than zero if the GTK version doesn't support |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
110 multipe displays. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
111 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
112 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
113 xg_display_open (char *display_name, Display **dpy) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
114 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
115 GdkDisplay *gdpy; |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
116 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
117 gdpy = gdk_display_open (display_name); |
102705
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
118 if (!gdpy_def && gdpy) |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
119 { |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
120 gdpy_def = gdpy; |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
121 gdk_display_manager_set_default_display (gdk_display_manager_get (), |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
122 gdpy); |
36389825b3d8
gtkutil.c (xg_display_open): Assign a value to gdpy_def, check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102549
diff
changeset
|
123 } |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
124 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
125 *dpy = gdpy ? GDK_DISPLAY_XDISPLAY (gdpy) : NULL; |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
126 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
127 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
128 |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
129 /* Close display DPY. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
130 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
131 void |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
132 xg_display_close (Display *dpy) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
133 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
134 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (dpy); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
135 |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
136 /* If this is the default display, try to change it before closing. |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
137 If there is no other display to use, gdpy_def is set to NULL, and |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
138 the next call to xg_display_open resets the default display. */ |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
139 if (gdk_display_get_default () == gdpy) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
140 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
141 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo; |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
142 GdkDisplay *gdpy_new = NULL; |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
143 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
144 /* Find another display. */ |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
145 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
146 if (dpyinfo->display != dpy) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
147 { |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
148 gdpy_new = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (dpyinfo->display); |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
149 gdk_display_manager_set_default_display (gdk_display_manager_get (), |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
150 gdpy_new); |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
151 break; |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
152 } |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
153 gdpy_def = gdpy_new; |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
154 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
155 |
72778
ab6be05ddfb1
* gtkutil.c (xg_display_close): Always change default display if needed,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72637
diff
changeset
|
156 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION == 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION < 10 |
98555
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
157 /* GTK 2.2-2.8 has a bug that makes gdk_display_close crash (bug |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
158 http://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). This way we |
440d088b9a23
(xg_display_open): Reset default display if none exists.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98545
diff
changeset
|
159 can continue running, but there will be memory leaks. */ |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
160 g_object_run_dispose (G_OBJECT (gdpy)); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
161 #else |
72778
ab6be05ddfb1
* gtkutil.c (xg_display_close): Always change default display if needed,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72637
diff
changeset
|
162 /* This seems to be fixed in GTK 2.10. */ |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
163 gdk_display_close (gdpy); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
164 #endif |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
165 } |
50129
d0142038feaa
Reduce flicker in GTK scrollbars.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50112
diff
changeset
|
166 |
49323 | 167 |
168 /*********************************************************************** | |
169 Utility functions | |
170 ***********************************************************************/ | |
171 /* The next two variables and functions are taken from lwlib. */ | |
172 static widget_value *widget_value_free_list; | |
173 static int malloc_cpt; | |
174 | |
175 /* Allocate a widget_value structure, either by taking one from the | |
176 widget_value_free_list or by malloc:ing a new one. | |
177 | |
178 Return a pointer to the allocated structure. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
179 |
49323 | 180 widget_value * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
181 malloc_widget_value (void) |
49323 | 182 { |
183 widget_value *wv; | |
184 if (widget_value_free_list) | |
185 { | |
186 wv = widget_value_free_list; | |
187 widget_value_free_list = wv->free_list; | |
188 wv->free_list = 0; | |
189 } | |
190 else | |
191 { | |
69025
5d9232b72d14
(malloc_widget_value): Use xmalloc.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
68922
diff
changeset
|
192 wv = (widget_value *) xmalloc (sizeof (widget_value)); |
49323 | 193 malloc_cpt++; |
194 } | |
195 memset (wv, 0, sizeof (widget_value)); | |
196 return wv; | |
197 } | |
198 | |
199 /* This is analogous to free. It frees only what was allocated | |
200 by malloc_widget_value, and no substructures. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
201 |
49323 | 202 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
203 free_widget_value (widget_value *wv) |
49323 | 204 { |
205 if (wv->free_list) | |
206 abort (); | |
207 | |
208 if (malloc_cpt > 25) | |
209 { | |
210 /* When the number of already allocated cells is too big, | |
211 We free it. */ | |
100633
5395c014feb8
* buffer.c (init_buffer): Use realloc instead of xrealloc.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
100501
diff
changeset
|
212 xfree (wv); |
49323 | 213 malloc_cpt--; |
214 } | |
215 else | |
216 { | |
217 wv->free_list = widget_value_free_list; | |
218 widget_value_free_list = wv; | |
219 } | |
220 } | |
221 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
222 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
223 /* Create and return the cursor to be used for popup menus and |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
224 scroll bars on display DPY. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
225 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
226 GdkCursor * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
227 xg_create_default_cursor (Display *dpy) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
228 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
229 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (dpy); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
230 return gdk_cursor_new_for_display (gdpy, GDK_LEFT_PTR); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
231 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
232 |
64936
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
233 /* Apply GMASK to GPIX and return a GdkPixbuf with an alpha channel. */ |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
234 |
65006
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
235 static GdkPixbuf * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
236 xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask (GdkPixmap *gpix, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
237 GdkPixmap *gmask, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
238 GdkColormap *cmap) |
64936
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
239 { |
107219
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
240 int width, height; |
64936
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
241 GdkPixbuf *icon_buf, *tmp_buf; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
242 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
243 gdk_drawable_get_size (gpix, &width, &height); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
244 tmp_buf = gdk_pixbuf_get_from_drawable (NULL, gpix, cmap, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
245 0, 0, 0, 0, width, height); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
246 icon_buf = gdk_pixbuf_add_alpha (tmp_buf, FALSE, 0, 0, 0); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
247 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (tmp_buf)); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
248 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
249 if (gmask) |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
250 { |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
251 GdkPixbuf *mask_buf = gdk_pixbuf_get_from_drawable (NULL, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
252 gmask, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
253 NULL, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
254 0, 0, 0, 0, |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
255 width, height); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
256 guchar *pixels = gdk_pixbuf_get_pixels (icon_buf); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
257 guchar *mask_pixels = gdk_pixbuf_get_pixels (mask_buf); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
258 int rowstride = gdk_pixbuf_get_rowstride (icon_buf); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
259 int mask_rowstride = gdk_pixbuf_get_rowstride (mask_buf); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
260 int y; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
261 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
262 for (y = 0; y < height; ++y) |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
263 { |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
264 guchar *iconptr, *maskptr; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
265 int x; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
266 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
267 iconptr = pixels + y * rowstride; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
268 maskptr = mask_pixels + y * mask_rowstride; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
269 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
270 for (x = 0; x < width; ++x) |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
271 { |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
272 /* In a bitmap, RGB is either 255/255/255 or 0/0/0. Checking |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
273 just R is sufficient. */ |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
274 if (maskptr[0] == 0) |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
275 iconptr[3] = 0; /* 0, 1, 2 is R, G, B. 3 is alpha. */ |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
276 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
277 iconptr += rowstride/width; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
278 maskptr += mask_rowstride/width; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
279 } |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
280 } |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
281 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
282 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (mask_buf)); |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
283 } |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
284 |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
285 return icon_buf; |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
286 } |
d5e998f50c2d
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64783
diff
changeset
|
287 |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
288 static Lisp_Object |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
289 file_for_image (Lisp_Object image) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
290 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
291 Lisp_Object specified_file = Qnil; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
292 Lisp_Object tail; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
293 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
294 for (tail = XCDR (image); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
295 NILP (specified_file) && CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
296 tail = XCDR (XCDR (tail))) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
297 if (EQ (XCAR (tail), QCfile)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
298 specified_file = XCAR (XCDR (tail)); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
299 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
300 return specified_file; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
301 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
302 |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
303 /* For the image defined in IMG, make and return a GtkImage. For displays with |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
304 8 planes or less we must make a GdkPixbuf and apply the mask manually. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
305 Otherwise the highlightning and dimming the tool bar code in GTK does |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
306 will look bad. For display with more than 8 planes we just use the |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
307 pixmap and mask directly. For monochrome displays, GTK doesn't seem |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
308 able to use external pixmaps, it looks bad whatever we do. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
309 The image is defined on the display where frame F is. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
310 WIDGET is used to find the GdkColormap to use for the GdkPixbuf. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
311 If OLD_WIDGET is NULL, a new widget is constructed and returned. |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
312 If OLD_WIDGET is not NULL, that widget is modified. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
313 |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
314 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
315 xg_get_image_for_pixmap (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
316 struct image *img, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
317 GtkWidget *widget, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
318 GtkImage *old_widget) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
319 { |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
320 GdkPixmap *gpix; |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
321 GdkPixmap *gmask; |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
322 GdkDisplay *gdpy; |
78809
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
323 GdkColormap *cmap; |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
324 GdkPixbuf *icon_buf; |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
325 |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
326 /* If we have a file, let GTK do all the image handling. |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
327 This seems to be the only way to make insensitive and activated icons |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
328 look good in all cases. */ |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
329 Lisp_Object specified_file = file_for_image (img->spec); |
69141
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
330 Lisp_Object file; |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
331 |
69141
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
332 /* We already loaded the image once before calling this |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
333 function, so this only fails if the image file has been removed. |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
334 In that case, use the pixmap already loaded. */ |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
335 |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
336 if (STRINGP (specified_file) |
6b335e9ea577
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If x_find_image_file returns
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
69025
diff
changeset
|
337 && STRINGP (file = x_find_image_file (specified_file))) |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
338 { |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
339 if (! old_widget) |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
340 old_widget = GTK_IMAGE (gtk_image_new_from_file (SSDATA (file))); |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
341 else |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
342 gtk_image_set_from_file (old_widget, SSDATA (file)); |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
343 |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
344 return GTK_WIDGET (old_widget); |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
345 } |
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
346 |
68027
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
347 /* No file, do the image handling ourselves. This will look very bad |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
348 on a monochrome display, and sometimes bad on all displays with |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
349 certain themes. */ |
606e8e24acfe
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): If the image is from a file,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67875
diff
changeset
|
350 |
56269
4f8b4f60e748
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Add workaround for monochrome displays
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56268
diff
changeset
|
351 gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
352 gpix = gdk_pixmap_foreign_new_for_display (gdpy, img->pixmap); |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
353 gmask = img->mask ? gdk_pixmap_foreign_new_for_display (gdpy, img->mask) : 0; |
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
354 |
78809
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
355 /* This is a workaround to make icons look good on pseudo color |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
356 displays. Apparently GTK expects the images to have an alpha |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
357 channel. If they don't, insensitive and activated icons will |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
358 look bad. This workaround does not work on monochrome displays, |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
359 and is strictly not needed on true color/static color displays (i.e. |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
360 16 bits and higher). But we do it anyway so we get a pixbuf that is |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
361 not associated with the img->pixmap. The img->pixmap may be removed |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
362 by clearing the image cache and then the tool bar redraw fails, since |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
363 Gtk+ assumes the pixmap is always there. */ |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
364 cmap = gtk_widget_get_colormap (widget); |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
365 icon_buf = xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask (gpix, gmask, cmap); |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
366 |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
367 if (! old_widget) |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
368 old_widget = GTK_IMAGE (gtk_image_new_from_pixbuf (icon_buf)); |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
369 else |
78809
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
370 gtk_image_set_from_pixbuf (old_widget, icon_buf); |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
371 |
c1d129148b98
(xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Always create a GdkPixbuf
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78787
diff
changeset
|
372 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (icon_buf)); |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
373 |
56268
9853134cd610
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Call g_object_unref on
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56112
diff
changeset
|
374 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gpix)); |
9853134cd610
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Call g_object_unref on
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56112
diff
changeset
|
375 if (gmask) g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gmask)); |
9853134cd610
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): Call g_object_unref on
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
56112
diff
changeset
|
376 |
56112
e4cfda8330d5
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_image_for_pixmap): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
55342
diff
changeset
|
377 return GTK_WIDGET (old_widget); |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
378 } |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
379 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
380 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
381 /* Set CURSOR on W and all widgets W contain. We must do like this |
49323 | 382 for scroll bars and menu because they create widgets internally, |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
383 and it is those widgets that are visible. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
384 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
385 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
386 xg_set_cursor (GtkWidget *w, GdkCursor *cursor) |
49323 | 387 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
388 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window(w); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
389 GList *children = gdk_window_peek_children (window); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
390 |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
391 gdk_window_set_cursor (window, cursor); |
49323 | 392 |
393 /* The scroll bar widget has more than one GDK window (had to look at | |
394 the source to figure this out), and there is no way to set cursor | |
395 on widgets in GTK. So we must set the cursor for all GDK windows. | |
396 Ditto for menus. */ | |
397 | |
398 for ( ; children; children = g_list_next (children)) | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
399 gdk_window_set_cursor (GDK_WINDOW (children->data), cursor); |
49323 | 400 } |
401 | |
402 /* Insert NODE into linked LIST. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
403 |
49323 | 404 static void |
405 xg_list_insert (xg_list_node *list, xg_list_node *node) | |
406 { | |
407 xg_list_node *list_start = list->next; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
408 |
49323 | 409 if (list_start) list_start->prev = node; |
410 node->next = list_start; | |
411 node->prev = 0; | |
412 list->next = node; | |
413 } | |
414 | |
415 /* Remove NODE from linked LIST. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
416 |
49323 | 417 static void |
418 xg_list_remove (xg_list_node *list, xg_list_node *node) | |
419 { | |
420 xg_list_node *list_start = list->next; | |
421 if (node == list_start) | |
422 { | |
423 list->next = node->next; | |
424 if (list->next) list->next->prev = 0; | |
425 } | |
426 else | |
427 { | |
428 node->prev->next = node->next; | |
429 if (node->next) node->next->prev = node->prev; | |
430 } | |
431 } | |
432 | |
433 /* Allocate and return a utf8 version of STR. If STR is already | |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
434 utf8 or NULL, just return a copy of STR. |
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
435 A new string is allocated and the caller must free the result |
49323 | 436 with g_free. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
437 |
49323 | 438 static char * |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
439 get_utf8_string (const char *str) |
49323 | 440 { |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
441 char *utf8_str; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
442 |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
443 if (!str) return NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
444 |
49323 | 445 /* If not UTF-8, try current locale. */ |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
446 if (!g_utf8_validate (str, -1, NULL)) |
49323 | 447 utf8_str = g_locale_to_utf8 (str, -1, 0, 0, 0); |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
448 else |
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
449 return g_strdup (str); |
49323 | 450 |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
451 if (!utf8_str) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
452 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
453 /* Probably some control characters in str. Escape them. */ |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
454 size_t nr_bad = 0; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
455 gsize bytes_read; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
456 gsize bytes_written; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
457 unsigned char *p = (unsigned char *)str; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
458 char *cp, *up; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
459 GError *error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
460 |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
461 while (! (cp = g_locale_to_utf8 ((char *)p, -1, &bytes_read, |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
462 &bytes_written, &error)) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
463 && error->code == G_CONVERT_ERROR_ILLEGAL_SEQUENCE) |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
464 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
465 ++nr_bad; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
466 p += bytes_written+1; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
467 g_error_free (error); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
468 error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
469 } |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
470 |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
471 if (error) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
472 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
473 g_error_free (error); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
474 error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
475 } |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
476 if (cp) g_free (cp); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
477 |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
478 up = utf8_str = xmalloc (strlen (str) + nr_bad * 4 + 1); |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
479 p = (unsigned char *)str; |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
480 |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
481 while (! (cp = g_locale_to_utf8 ((char *)p, -1, &bytes_read, |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
482 &bytes_written, &error)) |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
483 && error->code == G_CONVERT_ERROR_ILLEGAL_SEQUENCE) |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
484 { |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
485 strncpy (up, (char *)p, bytes_written); |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
486 sprintf (up + bytes_written, "\\%03o", p[bytes_written]); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
487 up[bytes_written+4] = '\0'; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
488 up += bytes_written+4; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
489 p += bytes_written+1; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
490 g_error_free (error); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
491 error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
492 } |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
493 |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
494 if (cp) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
495 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
496 strcat (utf8_str, cp); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
497 g_free (cp); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
498 } |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
499 if (error) |
72928
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
500 { |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
501 g_error_free (error); |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
502 error = NULL; |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
503 } |
790e14d9baae
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Try harder to convert to UTF8. Gtk+
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72778
diff
changeset
|
504 } |
49323 | 505 return utf8_str; |
506 } | |
507 | |
109749
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
508 /* Check for special colors used in face spec for region face. |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
509 The colors are fetched from the Gtk+ theme. |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
510 Return 1 if color was found, 0 if not. */ |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
511 |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
512 int |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
513 xg_check_special_colors (struct frame *f, |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
514 const char *color_name, |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
515 XColor *color) |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
516 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
517 int success_p = 0; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
518 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)) |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
519 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
520 if (strcmp ("gtk_selection_bg_color", color_name) == 0) |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
521 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
522 GtkStyle *gsty = gtk_widget_get_style (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
523 color->red = gsty->bg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].red; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
524 color->green = gsty->bg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].green; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
525 color->blue = gsty->bg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].blue; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
526 color->pixel = gsty->bg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].pixel; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
527 success_p = 1; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
528 } |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
529 else if (strcmp ("gtk_selection_fg_color", color_name) == 0) |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
530 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
531 GtkStyle *gsty = gtk_widget_get_style (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
532 color->red = gsty->fg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].red; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
533 color->green = gsty->fg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].green; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
534 color->blue = gsty->fg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].blue; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
535 color->pixel = gsty->fg[GTK_STATE_SELECTED].pixel; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
536 success_p = 1; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
537 } |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
538 } |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
539 |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
540 return success_p; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
541 } |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
542 |
49323 | 543 |
544 | |
545 /*********************************************************************** | |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
546 Tooltips |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
547 ***********************************************************************/ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
548 /* Gtk+ calls this callback when the parent of our tooltip dummy changes. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
549 We use that to pop down the tooltip. This happens if Gtk+ for some |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
550 reason wants to change or hide the tooltip. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
551 |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
552 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
553 |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
554 static void |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
555 hierarchy_ch_cb (GtkWidget *widget, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
556 GtkWidget *previous_toplevel, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
557 gpointer user_data) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
558 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
559 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) user_data; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
560 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
561 GtkWidget *top = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (x->ttip_lbl); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
562 |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
563 if (! top || ! GTK_IS_WINDOW (top)) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
564 gtk_widget_hide (previous_toplevel); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
565 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
566 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
567 /* Callback called when Gtk+ thinks a tooltip should be displayed. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
568 We use it to get the tooltip window and the tooltip widget so |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
569 we can manipulate the ourselves. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
570 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
571 Return FALSE ensures that the tooltip is not shown. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
572 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
573 static gboolean |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
574 qttip_cb (GtkWidget *widget, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
575 gint xpos, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
576 gint ypos, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
577 gboolean keyboard_mode, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
578 GtkTooltip *tooltip, |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
579 gpointer user_data) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
580 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
581 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) user_data; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
582 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
583 if (x->ttip_widget == NULL) |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
584 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
585 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "has-tooltip", FALSE, NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
586 x->ttip_widget = tooltip; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
587 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (tooltip)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
588 x->ttip_lbl = gtk_label_new (""); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
589 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (x->ttip_lbl)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
590 gtk_tooltip_set_custom (tooltip, x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
591 x->ttip_window = GTK_WINDOW (gtk_widget_get_toplevel (x->ttip_lbl)); |
111186
801b9f880236
* gtkutil.c (qttip_cb): Set title to empty for ATK (Bug#7278).
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
110683
diff
changeset
|
592 /* ATK needs an empty title for some reason. */ |
801b9f880236
* gtkutil.c (qttip_cb): Set title to empty for ATK (Bug#7278).
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
110683
diff
changeset
|
593 gtk_window_set_title (x->ttip_window, ""); |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
594 /* Realize so we can safely get screen later on. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
595 gtk_widget_realize (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
596 gtk_widget_realize (x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
597 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
598 g_signal_connect (x->ttip_lbl, "hierarchy-changed", |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
599 G_CALLBACK (hierarchy_ch_cb), f); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
600 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
601 return FALSE; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
602 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
603 |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
604 #endif /* USE_GTK_TOOLTIP */ |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
605 |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
606 /* Prepare a tooltip to be shown, i.e. calculate WIDTH and HEIGHT. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
607 Return zero if no system tooltip available, non-zero otherwise. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
608 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
609 int |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
610 xg_prepare_tooltip (FRAME_PTR f, |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
611 Lisp_Object string, |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
612 int *width, |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
613 int *height) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
614 { |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
615 #ifndef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
616 return 0; |
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
617 #else |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
618 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
619 GtkWidget *widget; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
620 GdkWindow *gwin; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
621 GdkScreen *screen; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
622 GtkSettings *settings; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
623 gboolean tt_enabled = TRUE; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
624 GtkRequisition req; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
625 Lisp_Object encoded_string; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
626 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
627 if (!x->ttip_lbl) return 0; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
628 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
629 BLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
630 encoded_string = ENCODE_UTF_8 (string); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
631 widget = GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
632 gwin = gtk_widget_get_window (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
633 screen = gdk_drawable_get_screen (gwin); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
634 settings = gtk_settings_get_for_screen (screen); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
635 g_object_get (settings, "gtk-enable-tooltips", &tt_enabled, NULL); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
636 if (tt_enabled) |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
637 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
638 g_object_set (settings, "gtk-enable-tooltips", FALSE, NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
639 /* Record that we disabled it so it can be enabled again. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
640 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (x->ttip_window), "restore-tt", |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
641 (gpointer)f); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
642 } |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
643 |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
644 /* Prevent Gtk+ from hiding tooltip on mouse move and such. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
645 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
646 (gtk_widget_get_display (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window))), |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
647 "gdk-display-current-tooltip", NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
648 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
649 /* Put out dummy widget in so we can get callbacks for unrealize and |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
650 hierarchy-changed. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
651 gtk_tooltip_set_custom (x->ttip_widget, widget); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
652 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
653 gtk_tooltip_set_text (x->ttip_widget, SDATA (encoded_string)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
654 gtk_widget_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window), &req); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
655 if (width) *width = req.width; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
656 if (height) *height = req.height; |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
657 |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
658 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
659 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
660 return 1; |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
661 #endif /* USE_GTK_TOOLTIP */ |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
662 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
663 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
664 /* Show the tooltip at ROOT_X and ROOT_Y. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
665 xg_prepare_tooltip must have been called before this function. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
666 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
667 void |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
668 xg_show_tooltip (FRAME_PTR f, int root_x, int root_y) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
669 { |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
670 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
671 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
672 if (x->ttip_window) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
673 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
674 BLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
675 gtk_window_move (x->ttip_window, root_x, root_y); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
676 gtk_widget_show_all (GTK_WIDGET (x->ttip_window)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
677 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
678 } |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
679 #endif |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
680 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
681 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
682 /* Hide tooltip if shown. Do nothing if not shown. |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
683 Return non-zero if tip was hidden, non-ero if not (i.e. not using |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
684 system tooltips). */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
685 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
686 int |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
687 xg_hide_tooltip (FRAME_PTR f) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
688 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
689 int ret = 0; |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
690 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
691 if (f->output_data.x->ttip_window) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
692 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
693 GtkWindow *win = f->output_data.x->ttip_window; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
694 BLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
695 gtk_widget_hide (GTK_WIDGET (win)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
696 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
697 if (g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (win), "restore-tt")) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
698 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
699 GdkWindow *gwin = gtk_widget_get_window (GTK_WIDGET (win)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
700 GdkScreen *screen = gdk_drawable_get_screen (gwin); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
701 GtkSettings *settings = gtk_settings_get_for_screen (screen); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
702 g_object_set (settings, "gtk-enable-tooltips", TRUE, NULL); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
703 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
704 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
705 |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
706 ret = 1; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
707 } |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
708 #endif |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
709 return ret; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
710 } |
49323 | 711 |
712 | |
713 /*********************************************************************** | |
714 General functions for creating widgets, resizing, events, e.t.c. | |
715 ***********************************************************************/ | |
716 | |
717 /* Make a geometry string and pass that to GTK. It seems this is the | |
718 only way to get geometry position right if the user explicitly | |
719 asked for a position when starting Emacs. | |
720 F is the frame we shall set geometry for. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
721 |
49323 | 722 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
723 xg_set_geometry (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 724 { |
107851
2a74858bccc0
Fix so top -10 and left -10 in frame parameters work.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
725 if (f->size_hint_flags & (USPosition | PPosition)) |
93427
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
726 { |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
727 int left = f->left_pos; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
728 int xneg = f->size_hint_flags & XNegative; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
729 int top = f->top_pos; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
730 int yneg = f->size_hint_flags & YNegative; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
731 char geom_str[32]; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
732 |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
733 if (xneg) |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
734 left = -left; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
735 if (yneg) |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
736 top = -top; |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
737 |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
738 sprintf (geom_str, "=%dx%d%c%d%c%d", |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
739 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), |
107891
bf5fce1e8e34
Set USER_POS in hint_flags to work around Cygwin problem.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107851
diff
changeset
|
740 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f), |
93427
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
741 (xneg ? '-' : '+'), left, |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
742 (yneg ? '-' : '+'), top); |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
743 |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
744 if (!gtk_window_parse_geometry (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
745 geom_str)) |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
746 fprintf (stderr, "Failed to parse: '%s'\n", geom_str); |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
747 } |
49323 | 748 } |
749 | |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
750 /* Clear under internal border if any. As we use a mix of Gtk+ and X calls |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
751 and use a GtkFixed widget, this doesn't happen automatically. */ |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
752 |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
753 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
754 xg_clear_under_internal_border (FRAME_PTR f) |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
755 { |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
756 if (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f) > 0) |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
757 { |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
758 GtkWidget *wfixed = f->output_data.x->edit_widget; |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
759 gtk_widget_queue_draw (wfixed); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
760 gdk_window_process_all_updates (); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
761 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
762 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
763 0, 0, |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
764 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
765 FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
766 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
767 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
768 0, 0, |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
769 FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
770 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f), 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
771 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
772 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
773 0, FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
774 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
775 FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
776 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
777 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
778 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
779 0, |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
780 FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
781 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f), 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
782 } |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
783 } |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
784 |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
785 /* Function to handle resize of our frame. As we have a Gtk+ tool bar |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
786 and a Gtk+ menu bar, we get resize events for the edit part of the |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
787 frame only. We let Gtk+ deal with the Gtk+ parts. |
49323 | 788 F is the frame to resize. |
789 PIXELWIDTH, PIXELHEIGHT is the new size in pixels. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
790 |
49323 | 791 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
792 xg_frame_resized (FRAME_PTR f, int pixelwidth, int pixelheight) |
49323 | 793 { |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
794 int rows, columns; |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
795 |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
796 if (pixelwidth == -1 && pixelheight == -1) |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
797 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
798 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f) && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
799 gdk_window_get_geometry (gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)), |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
800 0, 0, |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
801 &pixelwidth, &pixelheight, 0); |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
802 else return; |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
803 } |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
804 |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
805 |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
806 rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelheight); |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
807 columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, pixelwidth); |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
808 |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
809 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f) |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
810 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f) |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
811 || pixelwidth != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
812 || pixelheight != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) |
49323 | 813 { |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
814 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth; |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
815 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight; |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
816 |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
817 xg_clear_under_internal_border (f); |
100498
b5964e7e169b
(xg_frame_resized): Remove check if rows/columns have
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
100100
diff
changeset
|
818 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0); |
b5964e7e169b
(xg_frame_resized): Remove check if rows/columns have
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
100100
diff
changeset
|
819 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
b5964e7e169b
(xg_frame_resized): Remove check if rows/columns have
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
100100
diff
changeset
|
820 cancel_mouse_face (f); |
49323 | 821 } |
822 } | |
823 | |
93427
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
824 /* Resize the outer window of frame F after chainging the height. |
753ad51473c7
(xg_set_geometry): Fix indentation.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
93030
diff
changeset
|
825 COLUMNS/ROWS is the size the edit area shall have after the resize. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
826 |
49323 | 827 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
828 xg_frame_set_char_size (FRAME_PTR f, int cols, int rows) |
49323 | 829 { |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
830 int pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows) |
49323 | 831 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f); |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
832 int pixelwidth; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
833 |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
834 if (FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) == 0) |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
835 return; |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
836 |
49323 | 837 /* Take into account the size of the scroll bar. Always use the |
838 number of columns occupied by the scroll bar here otherwise we | |
839 might end up with a frame width that is not a multiple of the | |
840 frame's character width which is bad for vertically split | |
841 windows. */ | |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
842 f->scroll_bar_actual_width |
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
843 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f); |
49323 | 844 |
50099
a62497b91c74
Use generic compute_fringe_widths.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50063
diff
changeset
|
845 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0); |
49323 | 846 |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
847 /* FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH uses scroll_bar_actual_width, so call it |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
848 after calculating that value. */ |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
849 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
850 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f); |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
851 |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
852 |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
853 /* Do this before resize, as we don't know yet if we will be resized. */ |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
854 xg_clear_under_internal_border (f); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
855 |
49323 | 856 /* Must resize our top level widget. Font size may have changed, |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
857 but not rows/cols. */ |
49323 | 858 gtk_window_resize (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), |
859 pixelwidth, pixelheight); | |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
860 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, 0); |
103198
f63bce93c7a1
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Set frame pixel width/height to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103022
diff
changeset
|
861 |
105693
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
862 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
863 cancel_mouse_face (f); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
864 |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
865 /* We can not call change_frame_size for a mapped frame, |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
866 we can not set pixel width/height either. The window manager may |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
867 override our resize request, XMonad does this all the time. |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
868 The best we can do is try to sync, so lisp code sees the updated |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
869 size as fast as possible. |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
870 For unmapped windows, we can set rows/cols. When |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
871 the frame is mapped again we will (hopefully) get the correct size. */ |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
872 if (f->async_visible) |
105693
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
873 { |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
874 /* Must call this to flush out events */ |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
875 (void)gtk_events_pending (); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
876 gdk_flush (); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
877 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify); |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
878 } |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
879 else |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
880 { |
105693
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
881 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0); |
103690
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
882 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth; |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
883 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight; |
6cf0c4de552b
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Do set width/height if the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103688
diff
changeset
|
884 } |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
885 } |
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
886 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
887 /* Handle height/width changes (i.e. add/remove/move menu/toolbar). |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
888 The policy is to keep the number of editable lines. */ |
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
889 |
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
890 static void |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
891 xg_height_or_width_changed (FRAME_PTR f) |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
892 { |
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
893 gtk_window_resize (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
894 FRAME_TOTAL_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
895 FRAME_TOTAL_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)); |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
896 f->output_data.x->hint_flags = 0; |
53275
a07a0bae1990
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_set_char_size): Call x_wm_set_size_hint.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
53069
diff
changeset
|
897 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, 0, 0); |
49323 | 898 } |
899 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
900 /* Convert an X Window WSESC on display DPY to its corresponding GtkWidget. |
49323 | 901 Must be done like this, because GtkWidget:s can have "hidden" |
902 X Window that aren't accessible. | |
903 | |
904 Return 0 if no widget match WDESC. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
905 |
49323 | 906 GtkWidget * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
907 xg_win_to_widget (Display *dpy, Window wdesc) |
49323 | 908 { |
909 gpointer gdkwin; | |
910 GtkWidget *gwdesc = 0; | |
911 | |
912 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
913 |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
914 gdkwin = gdk_xid_table_lookup_for_display (gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (dpy), |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
915 wdesc); |
49323 | 916 if (gdkwin) |
917 { | |
918 GdkEvent event; | |
919 event.any.window = gdkwin; | |
920 gwdesc = gtk_get_event_widget (&event); | |
921 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
922 |
49323 | 923 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
924 return gwdesc; | |
925 } | |
926 | |
927 /* Fill in the GdkColor C so that it represents PIXEL. | |
928 W is the widget that color will be used for. Used to find colormap. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
929 |
49323 | 930 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
931 xg_pix_to_gcolor (GtkWidget *w, long unsigned int pixel, GdkColor *c) |
49323 | 932 { |
933 GdkColormap *map = gtk_widget_get_colormap (w); | |
934 gdk_colormap_query_color (map, pixel, c); | |
935 } | |
936 | |
109749
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
937 /* Callback called when the gtk theme changes. |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
938 We notify lisp code so it can fix faces used for region for example. */ |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
939 |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
940 static void |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
941 style_changed_cb (GObject *go, |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
942 GParamSpec *spec, |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
943 gpointer user_data) |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
944 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
945 struct input_event event; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
946 GdkDisplay *gdpy = (GdkDisplay *) user_data; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
947 const char *display_name = gdk_display_get_name (gdpy); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
948 |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
949 EVENT_INIT (event); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
950 event.kind = CONFIG_CHANGED_EVENT; |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
951 event.frame_or_window = make_string (display_name, strlen (display_name)); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
952 /* Theme doesn't change often, so intern is called seldom. */ |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
953 event.arg = intern ("theme-name"); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
954 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
955 } |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
956 |
49323 | 957 /* Create and set up the GTK widgets for frame F. |
958 Return 0 if creation failed, non-zero otherwise. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
959 |
49323 | 960 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
961 xg_create_frame_widgets (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 962 { |
963 GtkWidget *wtop; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
964 GtkWidget *wvbox, *whbox; |
49323 | 965 GtkWidget *wfixed; |
966 GdkColor bg; | |
967 GtkRcStyle *style; | |
968 char *title = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
969 |
49323 | 970 BLOCK_INPUT; |
971 | |
91632
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
972 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)) |
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
973 wtop = gtk_plug_new (f->output_data.x->parent_desc); |
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
974 else |
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
975 wtop = gtk_window_new (GTK_WINDOW_TOPLEVEL); |
370f67c176eb
(xg_create_frame_widgets): If frame is embedded, call
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
87649
diff
changeset
|
976 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
977 xg_set_screen (wtop, f); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
978 |
49323 | 979 wvbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
980 whbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
49323 | 981 wfixed = gtk_fixed_new (); /* Must have this to place scroll bars */ |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
982 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
983 if (! wtop || ! wvbox || ! whbox || ! wfixed) |
49323 | 984 { |
985 if (wtop) gtk_widget_destroy (wtop); | |
986 if (wvbox) gtk_widget_destroy (wvbox); | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
987 if (whbox) gtk_widget_destroy (whbox); |
49323 | 988 if (wfixed) gtk_widget_destroy (wfixed); |
989 | |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
990 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
49323 | 991 return 0; |
992 } | |
993 | |
994 /* Use same names as the Xt port does. I.e. Emacs.pane.emacs by default */ | |
995 gtk_widget_set_name (wtop, EMACS_CLASS); | |
996 gtk_widget_set_name (wvbox, "pane"); | |
67528
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
997 gtk_widget_set_name (wfixed, SSDATA (Vx_resource_name)); |
49323 | 998 |
999 /* If this frame has a title or name, set it in the title bar. */ | |
67528
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
1000 if (! NILP (f->title)) title = SSDATA (ENCODE_UTF_8 (f->title)); |
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
1001 else if (! NILP (f->name)) title = SSDATA (ENCODE_UTF_8 (f->name)); |
49323 | 1002 |
1003 if (title) gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (wtop), title); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1004 |
49323 | 1005 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = wtop; |
1006 FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f) = wfixed; | |
1007 f->output_data.x->vbox_widget = wvbox; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
1008 f->output_data.x->hbox_widget = whbox; |
49323 | 1009 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1010 gtk_widget_set_has_window (wfixed, TRUE); |
49323 | 1011 |
1012 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (wtop), wvbox); | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
1013 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wvbox), whbox, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
1014 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (whbox), wfixed, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
49323 | 1015 |
1016 if (FRAME_EXTERNAL_TOOL_BAR (f)) | |
1017 update_frame_tool_bar (f); | |
1018 | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1019 /* We don't want this widget double buffered, because we draw on it |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1020 with regular X drawing primitives, so from a GTK/GDK point of |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1021 view, the widget is totally blank. When an expose comes, this |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1022 will make the widget blank, and then Emacs redraws it. This flickers |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1023 a lot, so we turn off double buffering. */ |
49323 | 1024 gtk_widget_set_double_buffered (wfixed, FALSE); |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
1025 |
49323 | 1026 gtk_window_set_wmclass (GTK_WINDOW (wtop), |
67528
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
1027 SSDATA (Vx_resource_name), |
c5c00342184b
* gtkutil.c (SSDATA): New macro to remove compiler warnings.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
65628
diff
changeset
|
1028 SSDATA (Vx_resource_class)); |
49323 | 1029 |
1030 /* Add callback to do nothing on WM_DELETE_WINDOW. The default in | |
1031 GTK is to destroy the widget. We want Emacs to do that instead. */ | |
1032 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wtop), "delete-event", | |
1033 G_CALLBACK (gtk_true), 0); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1034 |
49323 | 1035 /* Convert our geometry parameters into a geometry string |
1036 and specify it. | |
1037 GTK will itself handle calculating the real position this way. */ | |
1038 xg_set_geometry (f); | |
107219
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1039 f->win_gravity |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1040 = gtk_window_get_gravity (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))); |
49323 | 1041 |
1042 gtk_widget_add_events (wfixed, | |
1043 GDK_POINTER_MOTION_MASK | |
1044 | GDK_EXPOSURE_MASK | |
1045 | GDK_BUTTON_PRESS_MASK | |
1046 | GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE_MASK | |
1047 | GDK_KEY_PRESS_MASK | |
1048 | GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY_MASK | |
1049 | GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY_MASK | |
1050 | GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE_MASK | |
1051 | GDK_STRUCTURE_MASK | |
1052 | GDK_VISIBILITY_NOTIFY_MASK); | |
1053 | |
1054 /* Must realize the windows so the X window gets created. It is used | |
1055 by callers of this function. */ | |
1056 gtk_widget_realize (wfixed); | |
1057 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = GTK_WIDGET_TO_X_WIN (wfixed); | |
1058 | |
1059 /* Since GTK clears its window by filling with the background color, | |
1060 we must keep X and GTK background in sync. */ | |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
1061 xg_pix_to_gcolor (wfixed, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f), &bg); |
49323 | 1062 gtk_widget_modify_bg (wfixed, GTK_STATE_NORMAL, &bg); |
1063 | |
1064 /* Also, do not let any background pixmap to be set, this looks very | |
1065 bad as Emacs overwrites the background pixmap with its own idea | |
1066 of background color. */ | |
1067 style = gtk_widget_get_modifier_style (wfixed); | |
1068 | |
1069 /* Must use g_strdup because gtk_widget_modify_style does g_free. */ | |
1070 style->bg_pixmap_name[GTK_STATE_NORMAL] = g_strdup ("<none>"); | |
1071 gtk_widget_modify_style (wfixed, style); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1072 |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
1073 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1074 /* Steal a tool tip window we can move ourselves. */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1075 f->output_data.x->ttip_widget = 0; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1076 f->output_data.x->ttip_lbl = 0; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1077 f->output_data.x->ttip_window = 0; |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
1078 gtk_widget_set_tooltip_text (wtop, "Dummy text"); |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1079 g_signal_connect (wtop, "query-tooltip", G_CALLBACK (qttip_cb), f); |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
1080 #endif |
49323 | 1081 |
109749
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1082 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1083 GdkScreen *screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (wtop); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1084 GtkSettings *gs = gtk_settings_get_for_screen (screen); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1085 /* Only connect this signal once per screen. */ |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1086 if (! g_signal_handler_find (G_OBJECT (gs), |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1087 G_SIGNAL_MATCH_FUNC, |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1088 0, 0, 0, |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1089 G_CALLBACK (style_changed_cb), |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1090 0)) |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1091 { |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1092 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (gs), "notify::gtk-theme-name", |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1093 G_CALLBACK (style_changed_cb), |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1094 gdk_screen_get_display (screen)); |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1095 } |
be18c3b67d66
Take colors for region face (selected text) from the Gtk+ theme.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109748
diff
changeset
|
1096 } |
49323 | 1097 |
1098 UNBLOCK_INPUT; | |
1099 | |
1100 return 1; | |
1101 } | |
1102 | |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1103 void |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1104 xg_free_frame_widgets (FRAME_PTR f) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1105 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1106 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1107 { |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1108 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1109 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1110 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow in xterm.c */ |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1111 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0; |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
1112 #ifdef USE_GTK_TOOLTIP |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1113 if (x->ttip_lbl) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1114 gtk_widget_destroy (x->ttip_lbl); |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1115 if (x->ttip_widget) |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1116 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (x->ttip_widget)); |
109615
09adf0d4c6d9
Don't use Gtk+ tooltip unless Gtk+ version => 2.14.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109604
diff
changeset
|
1117 #endif |
109604
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1118 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1119 } |
43eca6c9f493
Use Gtk+ tooltips by default for Gtk+ Emacs.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109581
diff
changeset
|
1120 |
49323 | 1121 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F. |
1122 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags | |
1123 that the window now has. | |
1124 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the User Position | |
1125 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0). */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1126 |
49323 | 1127 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1128 x_wm_set_size_hint (FRAME_PTR f, long int flags, int user_position) |
49323 | 1129 { |
98545
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1130 /* Must use GTK routines here, otherwise GTK resets the size hints |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1131 to its own defaults. */ |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1132 GdkGeometry size_hints; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1133 gint hint_flags = 0; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1134 int base_width, base_height; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1135 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1136 int win_gravity = f->win_gravity; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1137 |
107219
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1138 /* Don't set size hints during initialization; that apparently leads |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1139 to a race condition. See the thread at |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1140 http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/emacs-devel/2008-10/msg00033.html */ |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1141 if (NILP (Vafter_init_time) || !FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)) |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1142 return; |
07507204ac6f
Move declarations before statements.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106815
diff
changeset
|
1143 |
98545
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1144 if (flags) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1145 { |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1146 memset (&size_hints, 0, sizeof (size_hints)); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1147 f->output_data.x->size_hints = size_hints; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1148 f->output_data.x->hint_flags = hint_flags; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1149 } |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1150 else |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1151 flags = f->size_hint_flags; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1152 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1153 size_hints = f->output_data.x->size_hints; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1154 hint_flags = f->output_data.x->hint_flags; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1155 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1156 hint_flags |= GDK_HINT_RESIZE_INC | GDK_HINT_MIN_SIZE; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1157 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1158 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1159 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1160 hint_flags |= GDK_HINT_BASE_SIZE; |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
1161 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f); |
98545
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1162 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1163 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1164 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1165 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1166 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1167 size_hints.base_width = base_width; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1168 size_hints.base_height = base_height; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1169 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1170 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1171 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1172 /* These currently have a one to one mapping with the X values, but I |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1173 don't think we should rely on that. */ |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1174 hint_flags |= GDK_HINT_WIN_GRAVITY; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1175 size_hints.win_gravity = 0; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1176 if (win_gravity == NorthWestGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1177 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_NORTH_WEST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1178 else if (win_gravity == NorthGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1179 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_NORTH; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1180 else if (win_gravity == NorthEastGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1181 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_NORTH_EAST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1182 else if (win_gravity == WestGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1183 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_WEST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1184 else if (win_gravity == CenterGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1185 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_CENTER; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1186 else if (win_gravity == EastGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1187 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_EAST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1188 else if (win_gravity == SouthWestGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1189 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_SOUTH_WEST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1190 else if (win_gravity == SouthGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1191 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_SOUTH; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1192 else if (win_gravity == SouthEastGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1193 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_SOUTH_EAST; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1194 else if (win_gravity == StaticGravity) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1195 size_hints.win_gravity = GDK_GRAVITY_STATIC; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1196 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1197 if (user_position) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1198 { |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1199 hint_flags &= ~GDK_HINT_POS; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1200 hint_flags |= GDK_HINT_USER_POS; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1201 } |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1202 |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1203 if (hint_flags != f->output_data.x->hint_flags |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1204 || memcmp (&size_hints, |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1205 &f->output_data.x->size_hints, |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1206 sizeof (size_hints)) != 0) |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1207 { |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1208 BLOCK_INPUT; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1209 gtk_window_set_geometry_hints (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1210 NULL, &size_hints, hint_flags); |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1211 f->output_data.x->size_hints = size_hints; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1212 f->output_data.x->hint_flags = hint_flags; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1213 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
d19cd21bc42d
(x_wm_set_size_hint): Return immediately if called during
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
97076
diff
changeset
|
1214 } |
49323 | 1215 } |
1216 | |
1217 /* Change background color of a frame. | |
96363
f9d35151b907
American English spelling fix.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
95954
diff
changeset
|
1218 Since GTK uses the background color to clear the window, we must |
49323 | 1219 keep the GTK and X colors in sync. |
1220 F is the frame to change, | |
1221 BG is the pixel value to change to. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1222 |
49323 | 1223 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1224 xg_set_background_color (FRAME_PTR f, long unsigned int bg) |
49323 | 1225 { |
1226 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)) | |
1227 { | |
1228 GdkColor gdk_bg; | |
1229 | |
1230 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
1231 xg_pix_to_gcolor (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f), bg, &gdk_bg); | |
1232 gtk_widget_modify_bg (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f), GTK_STATE_NORMAL, &gdk_bg); | |
1233 UNBLOCK_INPUT; | |
1234 } | |
1235 } | |
1236 | |
1237 | |
65006
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1238 /* Set the frame icon to ICON_PIXMAP/MASK. This must be done with GTK |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1239 functions so GTK does not overwrite the icon. */ |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1240 |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1241 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1242 xg_set_frame_icon (FRAME_PTR f, Pixmap icon_pixmap, Pixmap icon_mask) |
65006
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1243 { |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1244 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1245 GdkPixmap *gpix = gdk_pixmap_foreign_new_for_display (gdpy, icon_pixmap); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1246 GdkPixmap *gmask = gdk_pixmap_foreign_new_for_display (gdpy, icon_mask); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1247 GdkPixbuf *gp = xg_get_pixbuf_from_pix_and_mask (gpix, gmask, NULL); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1248 |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1249 gtk_window_set_icon (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)), gp); |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1250 } |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1251 |
ec2fa2e1d4ea
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_frame_icon): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64936
diff
changeset
|
1252 |
49323 | 1253 |
1254 /*********************************************************************** | |
1255 Dialog functions | |
1256 ***********************************************************************/ | |
1257 /* Return the dialog title to use for a dialog of type KEY. | |
1258 This is the encoding used by lwlib. We use the same for GTK. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1259 |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
1260 static const char * |
49323 | 1261 get_dialog_title (char key) |
1262 { | |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
1263 const char *title = ""; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1264 |
49323 | 1265 switch (key) { |
1266 case 'E': case 'e': | |
1267 title = "Error"; | |
1268 break; | |
1269 | |
1270 case 'I': case 'i': | |
1271 title = "Information"; | |
1272 break; | |
1273 | |
1274 case 'L': case 'l': | |
1275 title = "Prompt"; | |
1276 break; | |
1277 | |
1278 case 'P': case 'p': | |
1279 title = "Prompt"; | |
1280 break; | |
1281 | |
1282 case 'Q': case 'q': | |
1283 title = "Question"; | |
1284 break; | |
1285 } | |
1286 | |
1287 return title; | |
1288 } | |
1289 | |
1290 /* Callback for dialogs that get WM_DELETE_WINDOW. We pop down | |
1291 the dialog, but return TRUE so the event does not propagate further | |
1292 in GTK. This prevents GTK from destroying the dialog widget automatically | |
1293 and we can always destrou the widget manually, regardles of how | |
1294 it was popped down (button press or WM_DELETE_WINDOW). | |
1295 W is the dialog widget. | |
1296 EVENT is the GdkEvent that represents WM_DELETE_WINDOW (not used). | |
1297 user_data is NULL (not used). | |
1298 | |
1299 Returns TRUE to end propagation of event. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1300 |
49323 | 1301 static gboolean |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1302 dialog_delete_callback (GtkWidget *w, GdkEvent *event, gpointer user_data) |
49323 | 1303 { |
1304 gtk_widget_unmap (w); | |
1305 return TRUE; | |
1306 } | |
1307 | |
1308 /* Create a popup dialog window. See also xg_create_widget below. | |
1309 WV is a widget_value describing the dialog. | |
1310 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a button has been pressed. | |
1311 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when the dialog pops down. | |
1312 | |
1313 Returns the GTK dialog widget. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1314 |
49323 | 1315 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1316 create_dialog (widget_value *wv, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1317 GCallback select_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1318 GCallback deactivate_cb) |
49323 | 1319 { |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
1320 const char *title = get_dialog_title (wv->name[0]); |
49323 | 1321 int total_buttons = wv->name[1] - '0'; |
1322 int right_buttons = wv->name[4] - '0'; | |
1323 int left_buttons; | |
1324 int button_nr = 0; | |
1325 int button_spacing = 10; | |
1326 GtkWidget *wdialog = gtk_dialog_new (); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1327 GtkDialog *wd = GTK_DIALOG (wdialog); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1328 GtkBox *cur_box = GTK_BOX (gtk_dialog_get_action_area (wd)); |
49323 | 1329 widget_value *item; |
1330 GtkWidget *wvbox; | |
1331 GtkWidget *whbox_up; | |
1332 GtkWidget *whbox_down; | |
1333 | |
1334 /* If the number of buttons is greater than 4, make two rows of buttons | |
1335 instead. This looks better. */ | |
1336 int make_two_rows = total_buttons > 4; | |
1337 | |
1338 if (right_buttons == 0) right_buttons = total_buttons/2; | |
1339 left_buttons = total_buttons - right_buttons; | |
1340 | |
1341 gtk_window_set_title (GTK_WINDOW (wdialog), title); | |
1342 gtk_widget_set_name (wdialog, "emacs-dialog"); | |
1343 | |
1344 | |
1345 if (make_two_rows) | |
1346 { | |
1347 wvbox = gtk_vbox_new (TRUE, button_spacing); | |
1348 whbox_up = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); | |
1349 whbox_down = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); | |
1350 | |
1351 gtk_box_pack_start (cur_box, wvbox, FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
1352 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wvbox), whbox_up, FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
1353 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wvbox), whbox_down, FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
1354 | |
1355 cur_box = GTK_BOX (whbox_up); | |
1356 } | |
1357 | |
1358 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wdialog), "delete-event", | |
1359 G_CALLBACK (dialog_delete_callback), 0); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1360 |
49323 | 1361 if (deactivate_cb) |
1362 { | |
1363 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wdialog), "close", deactivate_cb, 0); | |
1364 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wdialog), "response", deactivate_cb, 0); | |
1365 } | |
1366 | |
1367 for (item = wv->contents; item; item = item->next) | |
1368 { | |
1369 char *utf8_label = get_utf8_string (item->value); | |
1370 GtkWidget *w; | |
1371 GtkRequisition req; | |
1372 | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
1373 if (item->name && strcmp (item->name, "message") == 0) |
49323 | 1374 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1375 GtkBox *wvbox = GTK_BOX (gtk_dialog_get_content_area (wd)); |
49323 | 1376 /* This is the text part of the dialog. */ |
1377 w = gtk_label_new (utf8_label); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1378 gtk_box_pack_start (wvbox, gtk_label_new (""), FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1379 gtk_box_pack_start (wvbox, w, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
49323 | 1380 gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (w), 0.1, 0.5); |
1381 | |
1382 /* Try to make dialog look better. Must realize first so | |
1383 the widget can calculate the size it needs. */ | |
1384 gtk_widget_realize (w); | |
1385 gtk_widget_size_request (w, &req); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1386 gtk_box_set_spacing (wvbox, req.height); |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
1387 if (item->value && strlen (item->value) > 0) |
49323 | 1388 button_spacing = 2*req.width/strlen (item->value); |
1389 } | |
1390 else | |
1391 { | |
1392 /* This is one button to add to the dialog. */ | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
1393 w = gtk_button_new_with_label (utf8_label); |
49323 | 1394 if (! item->enabled) |
1395 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, FALSE); | |
1396 if (select_cb) | |
1397 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), "clicked", | |
1398 select_cb, item->call_data); | |
1399 | |
1400 gtk_box_pack_start (cur_box, w, TRUE, TRUE, button_spacing); | |
1401 if (++button_nr == left_buttons) | |
1402 { | |
1403 if (make_two_rows) | |
1404 cur_box = GTK_BOX (whbox_down); | |
1405 else | |
1406 gtk_box_pack_start (cur_box, | |
1407 gtk_label_new (""), | |
1408 TRUE, TRUE, | |
1409 button_spacing); | |
1410 } | |
1411 } | |
1412 | |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
1413 if (utf8_label) |
49323 | 1414 g_free (utf8_label); |
1415 } | |
1416 | |
1417 return wdialog; | |
1418 } | |
1419 | |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1420 struct xg_dialog_data |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1421 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1422 GMainLoop *loop; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1423 int response; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1424 GtkWidget *w; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1425 guint timerid; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1426 }; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1427 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1428 /* Function that is called when the file or font dialogs pop down. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1429 W is the dialog widget, RESPONSE is the response code. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1430 USER_DATA is what we passed in to g_signal_connect. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1431 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1432 static void |
109139
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1433 xg_dialog_response_cb (GtkDialog *w, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1434 gint response, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1435 gpointer user_data) |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1436 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1437 struct xg_dialog_data *dd = (struct xg_dialog_data *)user_data; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1438 dd->response = response; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1439 g_main_loop_quit (dd->loop); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1440 } |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1441 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1442 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1443 /* Destroy the dialog. This makes it pop down. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1444 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1445 static Lisp_Object |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1446 pop_down_dialog (Lisp_Object arg) |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1447 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1448 struct Lisp_Save_Value *p = XSAVE_VALUE (arg); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1449 struct xg_dialog_data *dd = (struct xg_dialog_data *) p->pointer; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1450 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1451 BLOCK_INPUT; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1452 if (dd->w) gtk_widget_destroy (dd->w); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1453 if (dd->timerid != 0) g_source_remove (dd->timerid); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1454 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1455 g_main_loop_quit (dd->loop); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1456 g_main_loop_unref (dd->loop); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
1457 |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1458 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1459 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1460 return Qnil; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1461 } |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1462 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1463 /* If there are any emacs timers pending, add a timeout to main loop in DATA. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1464 We pass in DATA as gpointer* so we can use this as a callback. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1465 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1466 static gboolean |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1467 xg_maybe_add_timer (gpointer data) |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1468 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1469 struct xg_dialog_data *dd = (struct xg_dialog_data *) data; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1470 EMACS_TIME next_time = timer_check (1); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1471 long secs = EMACS_SECS (next_time); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1472 long usecs = EMACS_USECS (next_time); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1473 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1474 dd->timerid = 0; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1475 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1476 if (secs >= 0 && usecs >= 0 && secs < ((guint)-1)/1000) |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1477 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1478 dd->timerid = g_timeout_add (secs * 1000 + usecs/1000, |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1479 xg_maybe_add_timer, |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1480 dd); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1481 } |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1482 return FALSE; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1483 } |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1484 |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
1485 |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1486 /* Pops up a modal dialog W and waits for response. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1487 We don't use gtk_dialog_run because we want to process emacs timers. |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1488 The dialog W is not destroyed when this function returns. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1489 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1490 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1491 xg_dialog_run (FRAME_PTR f, GtkWidget *w) |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1492 { |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1493 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX (); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1494 struct xg_dialog_data dd; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1495 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1496 xg_set_screen (w, f); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1497 gtk_window_set_transient_for (GTK_WINDOW (w), |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1498 GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1499 gtk_window_set_destroy_with_parent (GTK_WINDOW (w), TRUE); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1500 gtk_window_set_modal (GTK_WINDOW (w), TRUE); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1501 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1502 dd.loop = g_main_loop_new (NULL, FALSE); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1503 dd.response = GTK_RESPONSE_CANCEL; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1504 dd.w = w; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1505 dd.timerid = 0; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1506 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1507 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1508 "response", |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1509 G_CALLBACK (xg_dialog_response_cb), |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1510 &dd); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1511 /* Don't destroy the widget if closed by the window manager close button. */ |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1512 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), "delete-event", G_CALLBACK (gtk_true), NULL); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1513 gtk_widget_show (w); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1514 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1515 record_unwind_protect (pop_down_dialog, make_save_value (&dd, 0)); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1516 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1517 (void) xg_maybe_add_timer (&dd); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1518 g_main_loop_run (dd.loop); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
1519 |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1520 dd.w = 0; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1521 unbind_to (count, Qnil); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1522 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1523 return dd.response; |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1524 } |
49323 | 1525 |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1526 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1527 /*********************************************************************** |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1528 File dialog functions |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1529 ***********************************************************************/ |
67761
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1530 /* Return non-zero if the old file selection dialog is being used. |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1531 Return zero if not. */ |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1532 |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1533 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1534 xg_uses_old_file_dialog (void) |
67761
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1535 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1536 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW |
72963
e5e5fcf4397e
* gtkutil.c (xg_uses_old_file_dialog): Rename x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72931
diff
changeset
|
1537 extern int x_gtk_use_old_file_dialog; |
e5e5fcf4397e
* gtkutil.c (xg_uses_old_file_dialog): Rename x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72931
diff
changeset
|
1538 return x_gtk_use_old_file_dialog; |
67761
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1539 #else |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1540 return 0; |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1541 #endif |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1542 } |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1543 |
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1544 |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109067
diff
changeset
|
1545 typedef char * (*xg_get_file_func) (GtkWidget *); |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1546 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1547 /* Return the selected file for file chooser dialog W. |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1548 The returned string must be free:d. */ |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1549 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1550 static char * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1551 xg_get_file_name_from_chooser (GtkWidget *w) |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1552 { |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1553 return gtk_file_chooser_get_filename (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (w)); |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1554 } |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1555 |
68100
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1556 /* Callback called when the "Show hidden files" toggle is pressed. |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1557 WIDGET is the toggle widget, DATA is the file chooser dialog. */ |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1558 |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1559 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1560 xg_toggle_visibility_cb (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data) |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1561 { |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1562 GtkFileChooser *dialog = GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (data); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1563 gboolean visible; |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1564 g_object_get (G_OBJECT (dialog), "show-hidden", &visible, NULL); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1565 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (dialog), "show-hidden", !visible, NULL); |
68100
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1566 } |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1567 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1568 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1569 /* Callback called when a property changes in a file chooser. |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1570 GOBJECT is the file chooser dialog, ARG1 describes the property. |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1571 USER_DATA is the toggle widget in the file chooser dialog. |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1572 We use this to update the "Show hidden files" toggle when the user |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1573 changes that property by right clicking in the file list. */ |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1574 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1575 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1576 xg_toggle_notify_cb (GObject *gobject, GParamSpec *arg1, gpointer user_data) |
68100
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1577 { |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1578 extern int x_gtk_show_hidden_files; |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1579 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1580 if (strcmp (arg1->name, "show-hidden") == 0) |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1581 { |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1582 GtkWidget *wtoggle = GTK_WIDGET (user_data); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1583 gboolean visible, toggle_on; |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1584 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1585 g_object_get (G_OBJECT (gobject), "show-hidden", &visible, NULL); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1586 toggle_on = gtk_toggle_button_get_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (wtoggle)); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1587 |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1588 if (!!visible != !!toggle_on) |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1589 { |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1590 g_signal_handlers_block_by_func (G_OBJECT (wtoggle), |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1591 G_CALLBACK (xg_toggle_visibility_cb), |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1592 gobject); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1593 gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (wtoggle), visible); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1594 g_signal_handlers_unblock_by_func |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1595 (G_OBJECT (wtoggle), |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1596 G_CALLBACK (xg_toggle_visibility_cb), |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1597 gobject); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1598 } |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1599 x_gtk_show_hidden_files = visible; |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1600 } |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1601 } |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1602 |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1603 /* Read a file name from the user using a file chooser dialog. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1604 F is the current frame. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1605 PROMPT is a prompt to show to the user. May not be NULL. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1606 DEFAULT_FILENAME is a default selection to be displayed. May be NULL. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1607 If MUSTMATCH_P is non-zero, the returned file name must be an existing |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1608 file. *FUNC is set to a function that can be used to retrieve the |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1609 selected file name from the returned widget. |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1610 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1611 Returns the created widget. */ |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1612 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1613 static GtkWidget * |
109139
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1614 xg_get_file_with_chooser (FRAME_PTR f, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1615 char *prompt, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1616 char *default_filename, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1617 int mustmatch_p, int only_dir_p, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
1618 xg_get_file_func *func) |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1619 { |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1620 char message[1024]; |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1621 |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1622 GtkWidget *filewin, *wtoggle, *wbox, *wmessage; |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1623 GtkWindow *gwin = GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)); |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1624 GtkFileChooserAction action = (mustmatch_p ? |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1625 GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_OPEN : |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1626 GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_SAVE); |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1627 extern int x_gtk_show_hidden_files; |
72968
13a9a628ff21
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Rename x_gtk_show_chooser_help_text to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72963
diff
changeset
|
1628 extern int x_gtk_file_dialog_help_text; |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1629 |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1630 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1631 if (only_dir_p) |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1632 action = GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_SELECT_FOLDER; |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1633 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1634 filewin = gtk_file_chooser_dialog_new (prompt, gwin, action, |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1635 GTK_STOCK_CANCEL, GTK_RESPONSE_CANCEL, |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1636 (mustmatch_p || only_dir_p ? |
57900
a76858072e78
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Use GTK_STOCK_OK instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57868
diff
changeset
|
1637 GTK_STOCK_OPEN : GTK_STOCK_OK), |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1638 GTK_RESPONSE_OK, |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1639 NULL); |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1640 gtk_file_chooser_set_local_only (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), TRUE); |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1641 |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1642 wbox = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1643 gtk_widget_show (wbox); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1644 wtoggle = gtk_check_button_new_with_label ("Show hidden files."); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
1645 |
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
1646 if (x_gtk_show_hidden_files) |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1647 { |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1648 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (filewin), "show-hidden", TRUE, NULL); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1649 gtk_toggle_button_set_active (GTK_TOGGLE_BUTTON (wtoggle), TRUE); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1650 } |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1651 gtk_widget_show (wtoggle); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1652 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wtoggle), "clicked", |
68100
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1653 G_CALLBACK (xg_toggle_visibility_cb), filewin); |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1654 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (filewin), "notify", |
e5611feba7f7
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_notify_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68027
diff
changeset
|
1655 G_CALLBACK (xg_toggle_notify_cb), wtoggle); |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1656 |
72968
13a9a628ff21
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Rename x_gtk_show_chooser_help_text to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72963
diff
changeset
|
1657 if (x_gtk_file_dialog_help_text) |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1658 { |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1659 message[0] = '\0'; |
73048
4a83c4a89b5e
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Only chow C-l help for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72968
diff
changeset
|
1660 /* Gtk+ 2.10 has the file name text entry box integrated in the dialog. |
4a83c4a89b5e
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Only chow C-l help for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72968
diff
changeset
|
1661 Show the C-l help text only for versions < 2.10. */ |
73066 | 1662 if (gtk_check_version (2, 10, 0) && action != GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_SAVE) |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1663 strcat (message, "\nType C-l to display a file name text entry box.\n"); |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1664 strcat (message, "\nIf you don't like this file selector, use the " |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1665 "corresponding\nkey binding or customize " |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1666 "use-file-dialog to turn it off."); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
1667 |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1668 wmessage = gtk_label_new (message); |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1669 gtk_widget_show (wmessage); |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1670 } |
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1671 |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1672 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wbox), wtoggle, FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
72968
13a9a628ff21
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Rename x_gtk_show_chooser_help_text to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72963
diff
changeset
|
1673 if (x_gtk_file_dialog_help_text) |
72931
0ee8cea94c25
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Check
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72928
diff
changeset
|
1674 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wbox), wmessage, FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
67843
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1675 gtk_file_chooser_set_extra_widget (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), wbox); |
6cf5dc28bd1e
* gtkutil.c (xg_toggle_visibility_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67761
diff
changeset
|
1676 |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1677 if (default_filename) |
57940
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1678 { |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1679 Lisp_Object file; |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1680 struct gcpro gcpro1; |
78781
415fda17ec8f
(xg_get_file_with_chooser): Move GCPRO1 after declarations
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78762
diff
changeset
|
1681 char *utf8_filename; |
57940
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1682 GCPRO1 (file); |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1683 |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1684 file = build_string (default_filename); |
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1685 |
57940
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1686 /* File chooser does not understand ~/... in the file name. It must be |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1687 an absolute name starting with /. */ |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1688 if (default_filename[0] != '/') |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1689 file = Fexpand_file_name (file, Qnil); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
1690 |
72614
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1691 utf8_filename = SSDATA (ENCODE_UTF_8 (file)); |
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1692 if (! NILP (Ffile_directory_p (file))) |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1693 gtk_file_chooser_set_current_folder (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), |
72614
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1694 utf8_filename); |
58817
65f1b18b7f66
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Handle local files only.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58463
diff
changeset
|
1695 else |
72614
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1696 { |
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1697 gtk_file_chooser_set_filename (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), |
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1698 utf8_filename); |
72637
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1699 if (action == GTK_FILE_CHOOSER_ACTION_SAVE) |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1700 { |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1701 char *cp = strrchr (utf8_filename, '/'); |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1702 if (cp) ++cp; |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1703 else cp = utf8_filename; |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1704 gtk_file_chooser_set_current_name (GTK_FILE_CHOOSER (filewin), cp); |
9db8c9a68f0f
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Don't mention specific keys in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
72614
diff
changeset
|
1705 } |
72614
af91ff74c754
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Change file chooser message
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
71160
diff
changeset
|
1706 } |
57940
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1707 |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1708 UNGCPRO; |
a3fa0e63dd67
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_with_chooser): Expand DEFAULT_FILENAME if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57900
diff
changeset
|
1709 } |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1710 |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1711 *func = xg_get_file_name_from_chooser; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1712 return filewin; |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1713 } |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1714 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1715 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1716 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1717 /* Return the selected file for file selector dialog W. |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1718 The returned string must be free:d. */ |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1719 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1720 static char * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1721 xg_get_file_name_from_selector (GtkWidget *w) |
49323 | 1722 { |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1723 GtkFileSelection *filesel = GTK_FILE_SELECTION (w); |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1724 return xstrdup ((char*) gtk_file_selection_get_filename (filesel)); |
49323 | 1725 } |
1726 | |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1727 /* Create a file selection dialog. |
49323 | 1728 F is the current frame. |
1729 PROMPT is a prompt to show to the user. May not be NULL. | |
1730 DEFAULT_FILENAME is a default selection to be displayed. May be NULL. | |
1731 If MUSTMATCH_P is non-zero, the returned file name must be an existing | |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1732 file. *FUNC is set to a function that can be used to retrieve the |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1733 selected file name from the returned widget. |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1734 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1735 Returns the created widget. */ |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1736 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1737 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1738 xg_get_file_with_selection (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1739 char *prompt, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1740 char *default_filename, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1741 int mustmatch_p, int only_dir_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1742 xg_get_file_func *func) |
49323 | 1743 { |
1744 GtkWidget *filewin; | |
1745 GtkFileSelection *filesel; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1746 |
49323 | 1747 filewin = gtk_file_selection_new (prompt); |
1748 filesel = GTK_FILE_SELECTION (filewin); | |
1749 | |
1750 if (default_filename) | |
1751 gtk_file_selection_set_filename (filesel, default_filename); | |
1752 | |
1753 if (mustmatch_p) | |
1754 { | |
1755 /* The selection_entry part of filesel is not documented. */ | |
1756 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (filesel->selection_entry, FALSE); | |
1757 gtk_file_selection_hide_fileop_buttons (filesel); | |
1758 } | |
1759 | |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1760 *func = xg_get_file_name_from_selector; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1761 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1762 return filewin; |
49323 | 1763 } |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1764 #endif /* HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW */ |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1765 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1766 /* Read a file name from the user using a file dialog, either the old |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1767 file selection dialog, or the new file chooser dialog. Which to use |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1768 depends on what the GTK version used has, and what the value of |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1769 gtk-use-old-file-dialog. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1770 F is the current frame. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1771 PROMPT is a prompt to show to the user. May not be NULL. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1772 DEFAULT_FILENAME is a default selection to be displayed. May be NULL. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1773 If MUSTMATCH_P is non-zero, the returned file name must be an existing |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1774 file. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1775 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1776 Returns a file name or NULL if no file was selected. |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1777 The returned string must be freed by the caller. */ |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1778 |
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1779 char * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1780 xg_get_file_name (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1781 char *prompt, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1782 char *default_filename, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1783 int mustmatch_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1784 int only_dir_p) |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1785 { |
58284
10efc827e15c
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_name): Fix typo in
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58201
diff
changeset
|
1786 GtkWidget *w = 0; |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1787 char *fn = 0; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1788 int filesel_done = 0; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1789 xg_get_file_func func; |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1790 |
58818
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1791 #if defined (HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD) && defined (__SIGRTMIN) |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1792 /* I really don't know why this is needed, but without this the GLIBC add on |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1793 library linuxthreads hangs when the Gnome file chooser backend creates |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1794 threads. */ |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1795 sigblock (sigmask (__SIGRTMIN)); |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1796 #endif /* HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD */ |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1797 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1798 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW |
58463
86fddd350b35
* gtkutil.c (xg_get_file_name): Rename use-old-gtk-file-dialog to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58284
diff
changeset
|
1799 |
67761
5b8799d65159
* xfns.c (Fx_uses_old_gtk_dialog): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
67528
diff
changeset
|
1800 if (xg_uses_old_file_dialog ()) |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1801 w = xg_get_file_with_selection (f, prompt, default_filename, |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1802 mustmatch_p, only_dir_p, &func); |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1803 else |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1804 w = xg_get_file_with_chooser (f, prompt, default_filename, |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1805 mustmatch_p, only_dir_p, &func); |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1806 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1807 #else /* not HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW */ |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1808 w = xg_get_file_with_chooser (f, prompt, default_filename, |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1809 mustmatch_p, only_dir_p, &func); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
1810 #endif /* not HAVE_GTK_FILE_SELECTION_NEW */ |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1811 |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1812 gtk_widget_set_name (w, "emacs-filedialog"); |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1813 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1814 filesel_done = xg_dialog_run (f, w); |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1815 |
58818
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1816 #if defined (HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD) && defined (__SIGRTMIN) |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1817 sigunblock (sigmask (__SIGRTMIN)); |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1818 #endif |
f8cddae7d959
* gtkutil.c: Include signal.h and syssignal.h.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58817
diff
changeset
|
1819 |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1820 if (filesel_done == GTK_RESPONSE_OK) |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1821 fn = (*func) (w); |
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1822 |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1823 gtk_widget_destroy (w); |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
1824 return fn; |
57868
c955f6add62a
* fileio.c (Fread_file_name): Pass Qt as fifth parameter to
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57715
diff
changeset
|
1825 } |
49323 | 1826 |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1827 #ifdef HAVE_FREETYPE |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1828 /* Pop up a GTK font selector and return the name of the font the user |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1829 selects, as a C string. The returned font name follows GTK's own |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1830 format: |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1831 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1832 `FAMILY [VALUE1 VALUE2] SIZE' |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1833 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1834 This can be parsed using font_parse_fcname in font.c. |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1835 DEFAULT_NAME, if non-zero, is the default font name. */ |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1836 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1837 char * |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
1838 xg_get_font_name (FRAME_PTR f, const char *default_name) |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1839 { |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1840 GtkWidget *w; |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1841 char *fontname = NULL; |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1842 int done = 0; |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1843 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1844 #if defined (HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD) && defined (__SIGRTMIN) |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1845 sigblock (sigmask (__SIGRTMIN)); |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1846 #endif /* HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD */ |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1847 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1848 w = gtk_font_selection_dialog_new ("Pick a font"); |
105693
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
1849 if (!default_name) |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
1850 default_name = "Monospace 10"; |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
1851 gtk_font_selection_dialog_set_font_name (GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG (w), |
964ff7cbc8a6
Fix resize due to font change on a maximized/xmonad-controlled frame.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105669
diff
changeset
|
1852 default_name); |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1853 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1854 gtk_widget_set_name (w, "emacs-fontdialog"); |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1855 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1856 done = xg_dialog_run (f, w); |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1857 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1858 #if defined (HAVE_GTK_AND_PTHREAD) && defined (__SIGRTMIN) |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1859 sigunblock (sigmask (__SIGRTMIN)); |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1860 #endif |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1861 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1862 if (done == GTK_RESPONSE_OK) |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1863 fontname = gtk_font_selection_dialog_get_font_name |
105936
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1864 (GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG (w)); |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1865 |
45191c90be7e
Bug #4574. Common code for file/font dialog. Handle timers with glib-timers.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105880
diff
changeset
|
1866 gtk_widget_destroy (w); |
95794
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1867 return fontname; |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1868 } |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1869 #endif /* HAVE_FREETYPE */ |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1870 |
e4d692886628
(xg_dialog_response_cb): Rename from xg_file_response_callback.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
95481
diff
changeset
|
1871 |
49323 | 1872 |
1873 /*********************************************************************** | |
1874 Menu functions. | |
1875 ***********************************************************************/ | |
1876 | |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
1877 /* The name of menu items that can be used for customization. Since GTK |
49323 | 1878 RC files are very crude and primitive, we have to set this on all |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
1879 menu item names so a user can easily customize menu items. */ |
49323 | 1880 |
1881 #define MENU_ITEM_NAME "emacs-menuitem" | |
1882 | |
1883 | |
1884 /* Linked list of all allocated struct xg_menu_cb_data. Used for marking | |
1885 during GC. The next member points to the items. */ | |
1886 static xg_list_node xg_menu_cb_list; | |
1887 | |
1888 /* Linked list of all allocated struct xg_menu_item_cb_data. Used for marking | |
1889 during GC. The next member points to the items. */ | |
1890 static xg_list_node xg_menu_item_cb_list; | |
1891 | |
1892 /* Allocate and initialize CL_DATA if NULL, otherwise increase ref_count. | |
1893 F is the frame CL_DATA will be initialized for. | |
1894 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
1895 | |
1896 The menu bar and all sub menus under the menu bar in a frame | |
1897 share the same structure, hence the reference count. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
1898 |
49323 | 1899 Returns CL_DATA if CL_DATA is not NULL, or a pointer to a newly |
1900 allocated xg_menu_cb_data if CL_DATA is NULL. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1901 |
49323 | 1902 static xg_menu_cb_data * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1903 make_cl_data (xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data, FRAME_PTR f, GCallback highlight_cb) |
49323 | 1904 { |
1905 if (! cl_data) | |
1906 { | |
1907 cl_data = (xg_menu_cb_data*) xmalloc (sizeof (*cl_data)); | |
1908 cl_data->f = f; | |
1909 cl_data->menu_bar_vector = f->menu_bar_vector; | |
1910 cl_data->menu_bar_items_used = f->menu_bar_items_used; | |
1911 cl_data->highlight_cb = highlight_cb; | |
1912 cl_data->ref_count = 0; | |
1913 | |
1914 xg_list_insert (&xg_menu_cb_list, &cl_data->ptrs); | |
1915 } | |
1916 | |
1917 cl_data->ref_count++; | |
1918 | |
1919 return cl_data; | |
1920 } | |
1921 | |
1922 /* Update CL_DATA with values from frame F and with HIGHLIGHT_CB. | |
1923 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
1924 | |
1925 When the menu bar is updated, menu items may have been added and/or | |
1926 removed, so menu_bar_vector and menu_bar_items_used change. We must | |
1927 then update CL_DATA since it is used to determine which menu | |
1928 item that is invoked in the menu. | |
1929 HIGHLIGHT_CB could change, there is no check that the same | |
1930 function is given when modifying a menu bar as was given when | |
1931 creating the menu bar. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1932 |
49323 | 1933 static void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1934 update_cl_data (xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1935 FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
1936 GCallback highlight_cb) |
49323 | 1937 { |
1938 if (cl_data) | |
1939 { | |
1940 cl_data->f = f; | |
1941 cl_data->menu_bar_vector = f->menu_bar_vector; | |
1942 cl_data->menu_bar_items_used = f->menu_bar_items_used; | |
1943 cl_data->highlight_cb = highlight_cb; | |
1944 } | |
1945 } | |
1946 | |
1947 /* Decrease reference count for CL_DATA. | |
1948 If reference count is zero, free CL_DATA. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1949 |
49323 | 1950 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1951 unref_cl_data (xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data) |
49323 | 1952 { |
1953 if (cl_data && cl_data->ref_count > 0) | |
1954 { | |
1955 cl_data->ref_count--; | |
1956 if (cl_data->ref_count == 0) | |
1957 { | |
1958 xg_list_remove (&xg_menu_cb_list, &cl_data->ptrs); | |
1959 xfree (cl_data); | |
1960 } | |
1961 } | |
1962 } | |
1963 | |
1964 /* Function that marks all lisp data during GC. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1965 |
49323 | 1966 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1967 xg_mark_data (void) |
49323 | 1968 { |
1969 xg_list_node *iter; | |
1970 | |
1971 for (iter = xg_menu_cb_list.next; iter; iter = iter->next) | |
52080
c150d4a7aa36
gtkutil.c (xg_mark_data): Update calls to mark_object.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51569
diff
changeset
|
1972 mark_object (((xg_menu_cb_data *) iter)->menu_bar_vector); |
49323 | 1973 |
1974 for (iter = xg_menu_item_cb_list.next; iter; iter = iter->next) | |
1975 { | |
1976 xg_menu_item_cb_data *cb_data = (xg_menu_item_cb_data *) iter; | |
1977 | |
1978 if (! NILP (cb_data->help)) | |
52080
c150d4a7aa36
gtkutil.c (xg_mark_data): Update calls to mark_object.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51569
diff
changeset
|
1979 mark_object (cb_data->help); |
49323 | 1980 } |
1981 } | |
1982 | |
1983 | |
1984 /* Callback called when a menu item is destroyed. Used to free data. | |
1985 W is the widget that is being destroyed (not used). | |
1986 CLIENT_DATA points to the xg_menu_item_cb_data associated with the W. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
1987 |
49323 | 1988 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
1989 menuitem_destroy_callback (GtkWidget *w, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 1990 { |
1991 if (client_data) | |
1992 { | |
1993 xg_menu_item_cb_data *data = (xg_menu_item_cb_data*) client_data; | |
1994 xg_list_remove (&xg_menu_item_cb_list, &data->ptrs); | |
1995 xfree (data); | |
1996 } | |
1997 } | |
1998 | |
1999 /* Callback called when the pointer enters/leaves a menu item. | |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2000 W is the parent of the menu item. |
49323 | 2001 EVENT is either an enter event or leave event. |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2002 CLIENT_DATA is not used. |
49323 | 2003 |
2004 Returns FALSE to tell GTK to keep processing this event. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2005 |
49323 | 2006 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2007 menuitem_highlight_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2008 GdkEventCrossing *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2009 gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 2010 { |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2011 GdkEvent ev; |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2012 GtkWidget *subwidget; |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2013 xg_menu_item_cb_data *data; |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2014 |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2015 ev.crossing = *event; |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2016 subwidget = gtk_get_event_widget (&ev); |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2017 data = (xg_menu_item_cb_data *) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (subwidget), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2018 XG_ITEM_DATA); |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2019 if (data) |
49323 | 2020 { |
2021 if (! NILP (data->help) && data->cl_data->highlight_cb) | |
2022 { | |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2023 gpointer call_data = event->type == GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY ? 0 : data; |
49323 | 2024 GtkCallback func = (GtkCallback) data->cl_data->highlight_cb; |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2025 (*func) (subwidget, call_data); |
49323 | 2026 } |
2027 } | |
2028 | |
2029 return FALSE; | |
2030 } | |
2031 | |
2032 /* Callback called when a menu is destroyed. Used to free data. | |
2033 W is the widget that is being destroyed (not used). | |
2034 CLIENT_DATA points to the xg_menu_cb_data associated with W. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2035 |
49323 | 2036 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2037 menu_destroy_callback (GtkWidget *w, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 2038 { |
2039 unref_cl_data ((xg_menu_cb_data*) client_data); | |
2040 } | |
2041 | |
2042 /* Make a GTK widget that contains both UTF8_LABEL and UTF8_KEY (both | |
2043 must be non-NULL) and can be inserted into a menu item. | |
2044 | |
2045 Returns the GtkHBox. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2046 |
49323 | 2047 static GtkWidget * |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
2048 make_widget_for_menu_item (const char *utf8_label, const char *utf8_key) |
49323 | 2049 { |
2050 GtkWidget *wlbl; | |
2051 GtkWidget *wkey; | |
2052 GtkWidget *wbox; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2053 |
49323 | 2054 wbox = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2055 wlbl = gtk_label_new (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2056 wkey = gtk_label_new (utf8_key); |
2057 | |
2058 gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (wlbl), 0.0, 0.5); | |
2059 gtk_misc_set_alignment (GTK_MISC (wkey), 0.0, 0.5); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2060 |
49323 | 2061 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wbox), wlbl, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
2062 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (wbox), wkey, FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
2063 | |
2064 gtk_widget_set_name (wlbl, MENU_ITEM_NAME); | |
2065 gtk_widget_set_name (wkey, MENU_ITEM_NAME); | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
2066 gtk_widget_set_name (wbox, MENU_ITEM_NAME); |
49323 | 2067 |
2068 return wbox; | |
2069 } | |
2070 | |
2071 /* Make and return a menu item widget with the key to the right. | |
2072 UTF8_LABEL is the text for the menu item (GTK uses UTF8 internally). | |
2073 UTF8_KEY is the text representing the key binding. | |
2074 ITEM is the widget_value describing the menu item. | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2075 |
49323 | 2076 GROUP is an in/out parameter. If the menu item to be created is not |
2077 part of any radio menu group, *GROUP contains NULL on entry and exit. | |
2078 If the menu item to be created is part of a radio menu group, on entry | |
2079 *GROUP contains the group to use, or NULL if this is the first item | |
2080 in the group. On exit, *GROUP contains the radio item group. | |
2081 | |
2082 Unfortunately, keys don't line up as nicely as in Motif, | |
2083 but the MacOS X version doesn't either, so I guess that is OK. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2084 |
49323 | 2085 static GtkWidget * |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
2086 make_menu_item (const char *utf8_label, |
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
2087 const char *utf8_key, |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2088 widget_value *item, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2089 GSList **group) |
49323 | 2090 { |
2091 GtkWidget *w; | |
2092 GtkWidget *wtoadd = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2093 |
51432
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2094 /* It has been observed that some menu items have a NULL name field. |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2095 This will lead to this function being called with a NULL utf8_label. |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2096 GTK crashes on that so we set a blank label. Why there is a NULL |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2097 name remains to be investigated. */ |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2098 if (! utf8_label) utf8_label = " "; |
6db55492aca9
* gtkutil.c (make_menu_item): Make sure we don't crash on a NULL
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
51408
diff
changeset
|
2099 |
49323 | 2100 if (utf8_key) |
2101 wtoadd = make_widget_for_menu_item (utf8_label, utf8_key); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2102 |
49323 | 2103 if (item->button_type == BUTTON_TYPE_TOGGLE) |
2104 { | |
2105 *group = NULL; | |
2106 if (utf8_key) w = gtk_check_menu_item_new (); | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2107 else w = gtk_check_menu_item_new_with_label (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2108 gtk_check_menu_item_set_active (GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w), item->selected); |
2109 } | |
2110 else if (item->button_type == BUTTON_TYPE_RADIO) | |
2111 { | |
2112 if (utf8_key) w = gtk_radio_menu_item_new (*group); | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2113 else w = gtk_radio_menu_item_new_with_label (*group, utf8_label); |
49323 | 2114 *group = gtk_radio_menu_item_get_group (GTK_RADIO_MENU_ITEM (w)); |
2115 if (item->selected) | |
2116 gtk_check_menu_item_set_active (GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w), TRUE); | |
2117 } | |
2118 else | |
2119 { | |
2120 *group = NULL; | |
2121 if (utf8_key) w = gtk_menu_item_new (); | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2122 else w = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2123 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2124 |
49323 | 2125 if (wtoadd) gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (w), wtoadd); |
2126 if (! item->enabled) gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, FALSE); | |
2127 | |
2128 return w; | |
2129 } | |
2130 | |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2131 /* Return non-zero if LABEL specifies a separator (GTK only has one |
49323 | 2132 separator type) */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2133 |
105959
ba3ffbd9c422
* process.c (ifflag_def): Make flag_sym constant.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
105936
diff
changeset
|
2134 static const char* separator_names[] = { |
78787
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2135 "space", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2136 "no-line", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2137 "single-line", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2138 "double-line", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2139 "single-dashed-line", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2140 "double-dashed-line", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2141 "shadow-etched-in", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2142 "shadow-etched-out", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2143 "shadow-etched-in-dash", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2144 "shadow-etched-out-dash", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2145 "shadow-double-etched-in", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2146 "shadow-double-etched-out", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2147 "shadow-double-etched-in-dash", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2148 "shadow-double-etched-out-dash", |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2149 0, |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2150 }; |
96a27ec4e6c5
(xg_separator_p) <separator_names>: Move to file scope.
Glenn Morris <rgm@gnu.org>
parents:
78781
diff
changeset
|
2151 |
49323 | 2152 static int |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2153 xg_separator_p (const char *label) |
49323 | 2154 { |
50318
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2155 if (! label) return 0; |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2156 else if (strlen (label) > 3 |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2157 && strncmp (label, "--", 2) == 0 |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2158 && label[2] != '-') |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2159 { |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2160 int i; |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2161 |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2162 label += 2; |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2163 for (i = 0; separator_names[i]; ++i) |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2164 if (strcmp (label, separator_names[i]) == 0) |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2165 return 1; |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2166 } |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2167 else |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2168 { |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2169 /* Old-style separator, maybe. It's a separator if it contains |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2170 only dashes. */ |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2171 while (*label == '-') |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2172 ++label; |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2173 if (*label == 0) return 1; |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2174 } |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2175 |
5b50d76d9211
* gtkutil.c (xg_resize_widgets): Don't call xg_frame_cleared.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50272
diff
changeset
|
2176 return 0; |
49323 | 2177 } |
2178 | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2179 static int xg_detached_menus; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2180 |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2181 /* Returns non-zero if there are detached menus. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2182 |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2183 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2184 xg_have_tear_offs (void) |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2185 { |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2186 return xg_detached_menus > 0; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2187 } |
49323 | 2188 |
2189 /* Callback invoked when a detached menu window is removed. Here we | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2190 decrease the xg_detached_menus count. |
49323 | 2191 WIDGET is the top level window that is removed (the parent of the menu). |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2192 CLIENT_DATA is not used. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2193 |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2194 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2195 tearoff_remove (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 2196 { |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2197 if (xg_detached_menus > 0) --xg_detached_menus; |
49323 | 2198 } |
2199 | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2200 /* Callback invoked when a menu is detached. It increases the |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2201 xg_detached_menus count. |
49323 | 2202 WIDGET is the GtkTearoffMenuItem. |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2203 CLIENT_DATA is not used. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2204 |
49323 | 2205 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2206 tearoff_activate (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 2207 { |
2208 GtkWidget *menu = gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2209 if (gtk_menu_get_tearoff_state (GTK_MENU (menu))) |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2210 { |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2211 ++xg_detached_menus; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2212 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget)), |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2213 "destroy", |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2214 G_CALLBACK (tearoff_remove), 0); |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2215 } |
49323 | 2216 } |
2217 | |
2218 | |
2219 /* Create a menu item widget, and connect the callbacks. | |
2220 ITEM decribes the menu item. | |
2221 F is the frame the created menu belongs to. | |
2222 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2223 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
2224 CL_DATA points to the callback data to be used for this menu. | |
2225 GROUP is an in/out parameter. If the menu item to be created is not | |
2226 part of any radio menu group, *GROUP contains NULL on entry and exit. | |
2227 If the menu item to be created is part of a radio menu group, on entry | |
2228 *GROUP contains the group to use, or NULL if this is the first item | |
2229 in the group. On exit, *GROUP contains the radio item group. | |
2230 | |
2231 Returns the created GtkWidget. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2232 |
49323 | 2233 static GtkWidget * |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2234 xg_create_one_menuitem (widget_value *item, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2235 FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2236 GCallback select_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2237 GCallback highlight_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2238 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2239 GSList **group) |
49323 | 2240 { |
2241 char *utf8_label; | |
2242 char *utf8_key; | |
2243 GtkWidget *w; | |
2244 xg_menu_item_cb_data *cb_data; | |
2245 | |
2246 utf8_label = get_utf8_string (item->name); | |
2247 utf8_key = get_utf8_string (item->key); | |
2248 | |
2249 w = make_menu_item (utf8_label, utf8_key, item, group); | |
2250 | |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2251 if (utf8_label) g_free (utf8_label); |
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2252 if (utf8_key) g_free (utf8_key); |
49323 | 2253 |
2254 cb_data = xmalloc (sizeof (xg_menu_item_cb_data)); | |
2255 | |
2256 xg_list_insert (&xg_menu_item_cb_list, &cb_data->ptrs); | |
2257 | |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2258 cb_data->select_id = 0; |
49323 | 2259 cb_data->help = item->help; |
2260 cb_data->cl_data = cl_data; | |
2261 cb_data->call_data = item->call_data; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2262 |
49323 | 2263 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), |
2264 "destroy", | |
2265 G_CALLBACK (menuitem_destroy_callback), | |
2266 cb_data); | |
2267 | |
2268 /* Put cb_data in widget, so we can get at it when modifying menubar */ | |
2269 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (w), XG_ITEM_DATA, cb_data); | |
2270 | |
2271 /* final item, not a submenu */ | |
2272 if (item->call_data && ! item->contents) | |
2273 { | |
2274 if (select_cb) | |
2275 cb_data->select_id | |
2276 = g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), "activate", select_cb, cb_data); | |
2277 } | |
2278 | |
2279 return w; | |
2280 } | |
2281 | |
2282 /* Create a full menu tree specified by DATA. | |
2283 F is the frame the created menu belongs to. | |
2284 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2285 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when a sub menu is not shown anymore. | |
2286 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
2287 POP_UP_P is non-zero if we shall create a popup menu. | |
2288 MENU_BAR_P is non-zero if we shall create a menu bar. | |
2289 ADD_TEAROFF_P is non-zero if we shall add a teroff menu item. Ignored | |
2290 if MENU_BAR_P is non-zero. | |
2291 TOPMENU is the topmost GtkWidget that others shall be placed under. | |
2292 It may be NULL, in that case we create the appropriate widget | |
2293 (menu bar or menu item depending on POP_UP_P and MENU_BAR_P) | |
2294 CL_DATA is the callback data we shall use for this menu, or NULL | |
2295 if we haven't set the first callback yet. | |
2296 NAME is the name to give to the top level menu if this function | |
2297 creates it. May be NULL to not set any name. | |
2298 | |
2299 Returns the top level GtkWidget. This is TOPLEVEL if TOPLEVEL is | |
2300 not NULL. | |
2301 | |
2302 This function calls itself to create submenus. */ | |
2303 | |
2304 static GtkWidget * | |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2305 create_menus (widget_value *data, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2306 FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2307 GCallback select_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2308 GCallback deactivate_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2309 GCallback highlight_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2310 int pop_up_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2311 int menu_bar_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2312 int add_tearoff_p, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2313 GtkWidget *topmenu, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2314 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data, |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
2315 const char *name) |
49323 | 2316 { |
2317 widget_value *item; | |
2318 GtkWidget *wmenu = topmenu; | |
2319 GSList *group = NULL; | |
2320 | |
2321 if (! topmenu) | |
2322 { | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2323 if (! menu_bar_p) |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2324 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2325 wmenu = gtk_menu_new (); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2326 xg_set_screen (wmenu, f); |
75040
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2327 /* Connect this to the menu instead of items so we get enter/leave for |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2328 disabled items also. TODO: Still does not get enter/leave for |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2329 disabled items in detached menus. */ |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2330 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenu), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2331 "enter-notify-event", |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2332 G_CALLBACK (menuitem_highlight_callback), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2333 NULL); |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2334 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenu), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2335 "leave-notify-event", |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2336 G_CALLBACK (menuitem_highlight_callback), |
37202e2fc35f
(menuitem_highlight_callback): Invoked widget is the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75009
diff
changeset
|
2337 NULL); |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2338 } |
105522
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2339 else |
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2340 { |
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2341 wmenu = gtk_menu_bar_new (); |
106186
9b6f45dd8386
Use a select wrapper around the GLib event loop, thus taking into account GLib
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106161
diff
changeset
|
2342 /* Set width of menu bar to a small value so it doesn't enlarge |
9b6f45dd8386
Use a select wrapper around the GLib event loop, thus taking into account GLib
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106161
diff
changeset
|
2343 a small initial frame size. The width will be set to the |
9b6f45dd8386
Use a select wrapper around the GLib event loop, thus taking into account GLib
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106161
diff
changeset
|
2344 width of the frame later on when it is added to a container. |
9b6f45dd8386
Use a select wrapper around the GLib event loop, thus taking into account GLib
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106161
diff
changeset
|
2345 height -1: Natural height. */ |
105522
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2346 gtk_widget_set_size_request (wmenu, 1, -1); |
695dbf5b3bb9
gtkutil.c (create_menus): Call gtk_widget_set_size_request for
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103916
diff
changeset
|
2347 } |
49323 | 2348 |
2349 /* Put cl_data on the top menu for easier access. */ | |
2350 cl_data = make_cl_data (cl_data, f, highlight_cb); | |
2351 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wmenu), XG_FRAME_DATA, (gpointer)cl_data); | |
2352 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenu), "destroy", | |
2353 G_CALLBACK (menu_destroy_callback), cl_data); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2354 |
49323 | 2355 if (name) |
2356 gtk_widget_set_name (wmenu, name); | |
2357 | |
2358 if (deactivate_cb) | |
2359 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenu), | |
59913
b3664fca53d1
* gtkutil.c (create_menus): Connect selection-done event instead of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59666
diff
changeset
|
2360 "selection-done", deactivate_cb, 0); |
49323 | 2361 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2362 |
49323 | 2363 if (! menu_bar_p && add_tearoff_p) |
2364 { | |
2365 GtkWidget *tearoff = gtk_tearoff_menu_item_new (); | |
2366 gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (wmenu), tearoff); | |
2367 | |
2368 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (tearoff), "activate", | |
2369 G_CALLBACK (tearoff_activate), 0); | |
2370 } | |
2371 | |
2372 for (item = data; item; item = item->next) | |
2373 { | |
2374 GtkWidget *w; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2375 |
49323 | 2376 if (pop_up_p && !item->contents && !item->call_data |
2377 && !xg_separator_p (item->name)) | |
2378 { | |
2379 char *utf8_label; | |
2380 /* A title for a popup. We do the same as GTK does when | |
2381 creating titles, but it does not look good. */ | |
2382 group = NULL; | |
2383 utf8_label = get_utf8_string (item->name); | |
2384 | |
2385 gtk_menu_set_title (GTK_MENU (wmenu), utf8_label); | |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2386 w = gtk_menu_item_new_with_label (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2387 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, FALSE); |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2388 if (utf8_label) g_free (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2389 } |
2390 else if (xg_separator_p (item->name)) | |
2391 { | |
2392 group = NULL; | |
2393 /* GTK only have one separator type. */ | |
2394 w = gtk_separator_menu_item_new (); | |
2395 } | |
2396 else | |
2397 { | |
2398 w = xg_create_one_menuitem (item, | |
2399 f, | |
2400 item->contents ? 0 : select_cb, | |
2401 highlight_cb, | |
2402 cl_data, | |
2403 &group); | |
2404 | |
77511
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2405 /* Create a possibly empty submenu for menu bar items, since some |
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2406 themes don't highlight items correctly without it. */ |
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2407 if (item->contents || menu_bar_p) |
49323 | 2408 { |
2409 GtkWidget *submenu = create_menus (item->contents, | |
2410 f, | |
2411 select_cb, | |
2412 deactivate_cb, | |
2413 highlight_cb, | |
2414 0, | |
2415 0, | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2416 add_tearoff_p, |
49323 | 2417 0, |
2418 cl_data, | |
2419 0); | |
2420 gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (GTK_MENU_ITEM (w), submenu); | |
2421 } | |
2422 } | |
2423 | |
2424 gtk_menu_shell_append (GTK_MENU_SHELL (wmenu), w); | |
2425 gtk_widget_set_name (w, MENU_ITEM_NAME); | |
2426 } | |
2427 | |
2428 return wmenu; | |
2429 } | |
2430 | |
2431 /* Create a menubar, popup menu or dialog, depending on the TYPE argument. | |
2432 TYPE can be "menubar", "popup" for popup menu, or "dialog" for a dialog | |
2433 with some text and buttons. | |
2434 F is the frame the created item belongs to. | |
2435 NAME is the name to use for the top widget. | |
2436 VAL is a widget_value structure describing items to be created. | |
2437 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected or | |
2438 a dialog button is pressed. | |
2439 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when an item is deactivated. | |
2440 For a menu, when a sub menu is not shown anymore, for a dialog it is | |
2441 called when the dialog is popped down. | |
2442 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
2443 | |
2444 Returns the widget created. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2445 |
49323 | 2446 GtkWidget * |
109717
8949aad5e992
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109668
diff
changeset
|
2447 xg_create_widget (const char *type, const char *name, FRAME_PTR f, widget_value *val, |
109364
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2448 GCallback select_cb, GCallback deactivate_cb, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
2449 GCallback highlight_cb) |
49323 | 2450 { |
2451 GtkWidget *w = 0; | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2452 int menu_bar_p = strcmp (type, "menubar") == 0; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2453 int pop_up_p = strcmp (type, "popup") == 0; |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2454 |
49323 | 2455 if (strcmp (type, "dialog") == 0) |
2456 { | |
2457 w = create_dialog (val, select_cb, deactivate_cb); | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2458 xg_set_screen (w, f); |
49323 | 2459 gtk_window_set_transient_for (GTK_WINDOW (w), |
2460 GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))); | |
2461 gtk_window_set_destroy_with_parent (GTK_WINDOW (w), TRUE); | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2462 gtk_widget_set_name (w, "emacs-dialog"); |
58200
3608b64ba20f
* gtkutil.c (xg_file_sel_ok, xg_file_sel_cancel)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57941
diff
changeset
|
2463 gtk_window_set_modal (GTK_WINDOW (w), TRUE); |
49323 | 2464 } |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2465 else if (menu_bar_p || pop_up_p) |
49323 | 2466 { |
2467 w = create_menus (val->contents, | |
2468 f, | |
2469 select_cb, | |
2470 deactivate_cb, | |
2471 highlight_cb, | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2472 pop_up_p, |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2473 menu_bar_p, |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2474 menu_bar_p, |
49323 | 2475 0, |
2476 0, | |
2477 name); | |
2478 | |
2479 /* Set the cursor to an arrow for popup menus when they are mapped. | |
2480 This is done by default for menu bar menus. */ | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2481 if (pop_up_p) |
49323 | 2482 { |
2483 /* Must realize so the GdkWindow inside the widget is created. */ | |
2484 gtk_widget_realize (w); | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
2485 xg_set_cursor (w, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->xg_cursor); |
49323 | 2486 } |
2487 } | |
2488 else | |
2489 { | |
2490 fprintf (stderr, "bad type in xg_create_widget: %s, doing nothing\n", | |
2491 type); | |
2492 } | |
2493 | |
2494 return w; | |
2495 } | |
2496 | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2497 /* Return the label for menu item WITEM. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2498 |
49323 | 2499 static const char * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2500 xg_get_menu_item_label (GtkMenuItem *witem) |
49323 | 2501 { |
2502 GtkLabel *wlabel = GTK_LABEL (gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (witem))); | |
2503 return gtk_label_get_label (wlabel); | |
2504 } | |
2505 | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2506 /* Return non-zero if the menu item WITEM has the text LABEL. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2507 |
49323 | 2508 static int |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2509 xg_item_label_same_p (GtkMenuItem *witem, const char *label) |
49323 | 2510 { |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2511 int is_same = 0; |
49323 | 2512 char *utf8_label = get_utf8_string (label); |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2513 const char *old_label = witem ? xg_get_menu_item_label (witem) : 0; |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2514 |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2515 if (! old_label && ! utf8_label) |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2516 is_same = 1; |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2517 else if (old_label && utf8_label) |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2518 is_same = strcmp (utf8_label, old_label) == 0; |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2519 |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2520 if (utf8_label) g_free (utf8_label); |
49323 | 2521 |
2522 return is_same; | |
2523 } | |
2524 | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2525 /* Destroy widgets in LIST. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2526 |
49323 | 2527 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2528 xg_destroy_widgets (GList *list) |
49323 | 2529 { |
2530 GList *iter; | |
2531 | |
49572 | 2532 for (iter = list; iter; iter = g_list_next (iter)) |
49323 | 2533 { |
2534 GtkWidget *w = GTK_WIDGET (iter->data); | |
2535 | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2536 /* Destroying the widget will remove it from the container it is in. */ |
49323 | 2537 gtk_widget_destroy (w); |
2538 } | |
2539 } | |
2540 | |
2541 /* Update the top level names in MENUBAR (i.e. not submenus). | |
2542 F is the frame the menu bar belongs to. | |
49572 | 2543 *LIST is a list with the current menu bar names (menu item widgets). |
2544 ITER is the item within *LIST that shall be updated. | |
2545 POS is the numerical position, starting at 0, of ITER in *LIST. | |
49323 | 2546 VAL describes what the menu bar shall look like after the update. |
2547 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2548 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
49572 | 2549 CL_DATA points to the callback data to be used for this menu bar. |
49323 | 2550 |
2551 This function calls itself to walk through the menu bar names. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2552 |
49323 | 2553 static void |
109139
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2554 xg_update_menubar (GtkWidget *menubar, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2555 FRAME_PTR f, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2556 GList **list, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2557 GList *iter, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2558 int pos, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2559 widget_value *val, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2560 GCallback select_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2561 GCallback deactivate_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2562 GCallback highlight_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2563 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data) |
49323 | 2564 { |
49572 | 2565 if (! iter && ! val) |
49323 | 2566 return; |
49572 | 2567 else if (iter && ! val) |
49323 | 2568 { |
49572 | 2569 /* Item(s) have been removed. Remove all remaining items. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2570 xg_destroy_widgets (iter); |
49323 | 2571 |
106161
0ea716305b13
gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): If menubar is totally empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106012
diff
changeset
|
2572 /* Add a blank entry so the menubar doesn't collapse to nothing. */ |
0ea716305b13
gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): If menubar is totally empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106012
diff
changeset
|
2573 gtk_menu_shell_insert (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menubar), |
0ea716305b13
gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): If menubar is totally empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106012
diff
changeset
|
2574 gtk_menu_item_new_with_label (""), |
0ea716305b13
gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): If menubar is totally empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106012
diff
changeset
|
2575 0); |
49323 | 2576 /* All updated. */ |
2577 val = 0; | |
49572 | 2578 iter = 0; |
49323 | 2579 } |
49572 | 2580 else if (! iter && val) |
49323 | 2581 { |
2582 /* Item(s) added. Add all new items in one call. */ | |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2583 create_menus (val, f, select_cb, deactivate_cb, highlight_cb, |
49323 | 2584 0, 1, 0, menubar, cl_data, 0); |
2585 | |
2586 /* All updated. */ | |
2587 val = 0; | |
49572 | 2588 iter = 0; |
49323 | 2589 } |
49572 | 2590 /* Below this neither iter or val is NULL */ |
2591 else if (xg_item_label_same_p (GTK_MENU_ITEM (iter->data), val->name)) | |
49323 | 2592 { |
2593 /* This item is still the same, check next item. */ | |
2594 val = val->next; | |
49572 | 2595 iter = g_list_next (iter); |
2596 ++pos; | |
49323 | 2597 } |
2598 else /* This item is changed. */ | |
2599 { | |
49572 | 2600 GtkMenuItem *witem = GTK_MENU_ITEM (iter->data); |
49323 | 2601 GtkMenuItem *witem2 = 0; |
2602 int val_in_menubar = 0; | |
49572 | 2603 int iter_in_new_menubar = 0; |
2604 GList *iter2; | |
49323 | 2605 widget_value *cur; |
2606 | |
2607 /* See if the changed entry (val) is present later in the menu bar */ | |
49572 | 2608 for (iter2 = iter; |
2609 iter2 && ! val_in_menubar; | |
2610 iter2 = g_list_next (iter2)) | |
49323 | 2611 { |
49572 | 2612 witem2 = GTK_MENU_ITEM (iter2->data); |
49323 | 2613 val_in_menubar = xg_item_label_same_p (witem2, val->name); |
2614 } | |
2615 | |
49572 | 2616 /* See if the current entry (iter) is present later in the |
49323 | 2617 specification for the new menu bar. */ |
49572 | 2618 for (cur = val; cur && ! iter_in_new_menubar; cur = cur->next) |
2619 iter_in_new_menubar = xg_item_label_same_p (witem, cur->name); | |
2620 | |
2621 if (val_in_menubar && ! iter_in_new_menubar) | |
49323 | 2622 { |
49572 | 2623 int nr = pos; |
2624 | |
49323 | 2625 /* This corresponds to: |
2626 Current: A B C | |
2627 New: A C | |
2628 Remove B. */ | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2629 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2630 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (witem)); |
49323 | 2631 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar), GTK_WIDGET (witem)); |
2632 gtk_widget_destroy (GTK_WIDGET (witem)); | |
2633 | |
2634 /* Must get new list since the old changed. */ | |
49572 | 2635 g_list_free (*list); |
2636 *list = iter = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar)); | |
2637 while (nr-- > 0) iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
49323 | 2638 } |
49572 | 2639 else if (! val_in_menubar && ! iter_in_new_menubar) |
49323 | 2640 { |
2641 /* This corresponds to: | |
2642 Current: A B C | |
2643 New: A X C | |
2644 Rename B to X. This might seem to be a strange thing to do, | |
2645 since if there is a menu under B it will be totally wrong for X. | |
2646 But consider editing a C file. Then there is a C-mode menu | |
2647 (corresponds to B above). | |
2648 If then doing C-x C-f the minibuf menu (X above) replaces the | |
2649 C-mode menu. When returning from the minibuffer, we get | |
2650 back the C-mode menu. Thus we do: | |
2651 Rename B to X (C-mode to minibuf menu) | |
2652 Rename X to B (minibuf to C-mode menu). | |
2653 If the X menu hasn't been invoked, the menu under B | |
2654 is up to date when leaving the minibuffer. */ | |
2655 GtkLabel *wlabel = GTK_LABEL (gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (witem))); | |
2656 char *utf8_label = get_utf8_string (val->name); | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2657 GtkWidget *submenu = gtk_menu_item_get_submenu (witem); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2658 |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2659 gtk_label_set_text (wlabel, utf8_label); |
49323 | 2660 |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2661 /* If this item has a submenu that has been detached, change |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2662 the title in the WM decorations also. */ |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2663 if (submenu && gtk_menu_get_tearoff_state (GTK_MENU (submenu))) |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2664 /* Set the title of the detached window. */ |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2665 gtk_menu_set_title (GTK_MENU (submenu), utf8_label); |
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
2666 |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2667 if (utf8_label) g_free (utf8_label); |
49572 | 2668 iter = g_list_next (iter); |
49323 | 2669 val = val->next; |
49572 | 2670 ++pos; |
49323 | 2671 } |
49572 | 2672 else if (! val_in_menubar && iter_in_new_menubar) |
49323 | 2673 { |
2674 /* This corresponds to: | |
2675 Current: A B C | |
2676 New: A X B C | |
2677 Insert X. */ | |
2678 | |
49572 | 2679 int nr = pos; |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2680 GSList *group = 0; |
49323 | 2681 GtkWidget *w = xg_create_one_menuitem (val, |
2682 f, | |
2683 select_cb, | |
2684 highlight_cb, | |
2685 cl_data, | |
2686 &group); | |
2687 | |
77511
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2688 /* Create a possibly empty submenu for menu bar items, since some |
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2689 themes don't highlight items correctly without it. */ |
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2690 GtkWidget *submenu = create_menus (NULL, f, |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2691 select_cb, deactivate_cb, |
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2692 highlight_cb, |
77511
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2693 0, 0, 0, 0, cl_data, 0); |
49323 | 2694 gtk_widget_set_name (w, MENU_ITEM_NAME); |
2695 gtk_menu_shell_insert (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menubar), w, pos); | |
77511
1962a74982ce
(xg_update_menubar, create_menus): Create empty
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
76906
diff
changeset
|
2696 gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (GTK_MENU_ITEM (w), submenu); |
49323 | 2697 |
49572 | 2698 g_list_free (*list); |
2699 *list = iter = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar)); | |
2700 while (nr-- > 0) iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
2701 iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
49323 | 2702 val = val->next; |
49572 | 2703 ++pos; |
49323 | 2704 } |
49572 | 2705 else /* if (val_in_menubar && iter_in_new_menubar) */ |
49323 | 2706 { |
49572 | 2707 int nr = pos; |
49323 | 2708 /* This corresponds to: |
2709 Current: A B C | |
2710 New: A C B | |
2711 Move C before B */ | |
2712 | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2713 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (witem2)); |
49323 | 2714 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar), GTK_WIDGET (witem2)); |
2715 gtk_menu_shell_insert (GTK_MENU_SHELL (menubar), | |
2716 GTK_WIDGET (witem2), pos); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2717 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (witem2)); |
49323 | 2718 |
49572 | 2719 g_list_free (*list); |
2720 *list = iter = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar)); | |
2721 while (nr-- > 0) iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
76906
bb6e75c27940
(xg_update_menubar): Call g_list_next after moving
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75576
diff
changeset
|
2722 if (iter) iter = g_list_next (iter); |
49323 | 2723 val = val->next; |
49572 | 2724 ++pos; |
49323 | 2725 } |
2726 } | |
2727 | |
2728 /* Update the rest of the menu bar. */ | |
49572 | 2729 xg_update_menubar (menubar, f, list, iter, pos, val, |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
2730 select_cb, deactivate_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); |
49323 | 2731 } |
2732 | |
2733 /* Update the menu item W so it corresponds to VAL. | |
2734 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2735 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
102358 | 2736 CL_DATA is the data to set in the widget for menu invocation. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2737 |
49323 | 2738 static void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2739 xg_update_menu_item (widget_value *val, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2740 GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2741 GCallback select_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2742 GCallback highlight_cb, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
2743 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data) |
49323 | 2744 { |
2745 GtkWidget *wchild; | |
2746 GtkLabel *wlbl = 0; | |
2747 GtkLabel *wkey = 0; | |
2748 char *utf8_label; | |
2749 char *utf8_key; | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2750 const char *old_label = 0; |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2751 const char *old_key = 0; |
49323 | 2752 xg_menu_item_cb_data *cb_data; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2753 |
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2754 wchild = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (w)); |
49323 | 2755 utf8_label = get_utf8_string (val->name); |
2756 utf8_key = get_utf8_string (val->key); | |
2757 | |
2758 /* See if W is a menu item with a key. See make_menu_item above. */ | |
2759 if (GTK_IS_HBOX (wchild)) | |
2760 { | |
2761 GList *list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (wchild)); | |
2762 | |
2763 wlbl = GTK_LABEL (list->data); | |
2764 wkey = GTK_LABEL (list->next->data); | |
49572 | 2765 g_list_free (list); |
2766 | |
49323 | 2767 if (! utf8_key) |
2768 { | |
2769 /* Remove the key and keep just the label. */ | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2770 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (wlbl)); |
49323 | 2771 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (w), wchild); |
2772 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (w), GTK_WIDGET (wlbl)); | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2773 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (wlbl)); |
49323 | 2774 wkey = 0; |
2775 } | |
49572 | 2776 |
49323 | 2777 } |
2778 else /* Just a label. */ | |
2779 { | |
2780 wlbl = GTK_LABEL (wchild); | |
2781 | |
2782 /* Check if there is now a key. */ | |
2783 if (utf8_key) | |
2784 { | |
2785 GtkWidget *wtoadd = make_widget_for_menu_item (utf8_label, utf8_key); | |
2786 GList *list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (wtoadd)); | |
49572 | 2787 |
49323 | 2788 wlbl = GTK_LABEL (list->data); |
2789 wkey = GTK_LABEL (list->next->data); | |
49572 | 2790 g_list_free (list); |
49323 | 2791 |
2792 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (w), wchild); | |
2793 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (w), wtoadd); | |
2794 } | |
2795 } | |
2796 | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2797 |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2798 if (wkey) old_key = gtk_label_get_label (wkey); |
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2799 if (wlbl) old_label = gtk_label_get_label (wlbl); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2800 |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2801 if (wkey && utf8_key && (! old_key || strcmp (utf8_key, old_key) != 0)) |
49323 | 2802 gtk_label_set_text (wkey, utf8_key); |
2803 | |
49488
da6abcaef15c
gtkutil.c: Check for NULL string before calling strcmp or strlen.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49468
diff
changeset
|
2804 if (! old_label || strcmp (utf8_label, old_label) != 0) |
50778
f30e6f029d65
* gtkutil.c (create_dialog, make_widget_for_menu_item)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50521
diff
changeset
|
2805 gtk_label_set_text (wlbl, utf8_label); |
49323 | 2806 |
109748
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2807 if (utf8_key) g_free (utf8_key); |
e2f8226efb99
Fix -Wwrite_strings in general and for Gtk+ specific code.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109726
diff
changeset
|
2808 if (utf8_label) g_free (utf8_label); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2809 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2810 if (! val->enabled && gtk_widget_get_sensitive (w)) |
49323 | 2811 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, FALSE); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2812 else if (val->enabled && ! gtk_widget_get_sensitive (w)) |
49323 | 2813 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (w, TRUE); |
2814 | |
2815 cb_data = (xg_menu_item_cb_data*) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), | |
2816 XG_ITEM_DATA); | |
2817 if (cb_data) | |
2818 { | |
2819 cb_data->call_data = val->call_data; | |
2820 cb_data->help = val->help; | |
2821 cb_data->cl_data = cl_data; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2822 |
49323 | 2823 /* We assume the callback functions don't change. */ |
2824 if (val->call_data && ! val->contents) | |
2825 { | |
2826 /* This item shall have a select callback. */ | |
2827 if (! cb_data->select_id) | |
2828 cb_data->select_id | |
2829 = g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (w), "activate", | |
2830 select_cb, cb_data); | |
2831 } | |
2832 else if (cb_data->select_id) | |
2833 { | |
2834 g_signal_handler_disconnect (w, cb_data->select_id); | |
2835 cb_data->select_id = 0; | |
2836 } | |
2837 } | |
2838 } | |
2839 | |
2840 /* Update the toggle menu item W so it corresponds to VAL. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2841 |
49323 | 2842 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2843 xg_update_toggle_item (widget_value *val, GtkWidget *w) |
49323 | 2844 { |
2845 gtk_check_menu_item_set_active (GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w), val->selected); | |
2846 } | |
2847 | |
2848 /* Update the radio menu item W so it corresponds to VAL. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2849 |
49323 | 2850 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
2851 xg_update_radio_item (widget_value *val, GtkWidget *w) |
49323 | 2852 { |
2853 gtk_check_menu_item_set_active (GTK_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w), val->selected); | |
2854 } | |
2855 | |
2856 /* Update the sub menu SUBMENU and all its children so it corresponds to VAL. | |
2857 SUBMENU may be NULL, in that case a new menu is created. | |
2858 F is the frame the menu bar belongs to. | |
2859 VAL describes the contents of the menu bar. | |
2860 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
2861 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when a sub menu is not shown anymore. | |
2862 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. | |
2863 CL_DATA is the call back data to use for any newly created items. | |
2864 | |
2865 Returns the updated submenu widget, that is SUBMENU unless SUBMENU | |
2866 was NULL. */ | |
2867 | |
2868 static GtkWidget * | |
109139
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2869 xg_update_submenu (GtkWidget *submenu, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2870 FRAME_PTR f, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2871 widget_value *val, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2872 GCallback select_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2873 GCallback deactivate_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2874 GCallback highlight_cb, |
c25c24812fb1
Convert declarations or definitions to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109126
diff
changeset
|
2875 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data) |
49323 | 2876 { |
2877 GtkWidget *newsub = submenu; | |
2878 GList *list = 0; | |
2879 GList *iter; | |
2880 widget_value *cur; | |
2881 int has_tearoff_p = 0; | |
2882 GList *first_radio = 0; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2883 |
49323 | 2884 if (submenu) |
2885 list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (submenu)); | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2886 |
49323 | 2887 for (cur = val, iter = list; |
2888 cur && iter; | |
2889 iter = g_list_next (iter), cur = cur->next) | |
2890 { | |
2891 GtkWidget *w = GTK_WIDGET (iter->data); | |
2892 | |
2893 /* Skip tearoff items, they have no counterpart in val. */ | |
2894 if (GTK_IS_TEAROFF_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2895 { | |
2896 has_tearoff_p = 1; | |
2897 iter = g_list_next (iter); | |
2898 if (iter) w = GTK_WIDGET (iter->data); | |
2899 else break; | |
2900 } | |
2901 | |
2902 /* Remember first radio button in a group. If we get a mismatch in | |
2903 a radio group we must rebuild the whole group so that the connections | |
2904 in GTK becomes correct. */ | |
2905 if (cur->button_type == BUTTON_TYPE_RADIO && ! first_radio) | |
2906 first_radio = iter; | |
2907 else if (cur->button_type != BUTTON_TYPE_RADIO | |
2908 && ! GTK_IS_RADIO_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2909 first_radio = 0; | |
2910 | |
2911 if (GTK_IS_SEPARATOR_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2912 { | |
2913 if (! xg_separator_p (cur->name)) | |
2914 break; | |
2915 } | |
2916 else if (GTK_IS_CHECK_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2917 { | |
2918 if (cur->button_type != BUTTON_TYPE_TOGGLE) | |
2919 break; | |
2920 xg_update_toggle_item (cur, w); | |
2921 xg_update_menu_item (cur, w, select_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); | |
2922 } | |
2923 else if (GTK_IS_RADIO_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2924 { | |
2925 if (cur->button_type != BUTTON_TYPE_RADIO) | |
2926 break; | |
2927 xg_update_radio_item (cur, w); | |
2928 xg_update_menu_item (cur, w, select_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); | |
2929 } | |
2930 else if (GTK_IS_MENU_ITEM (w)) | |
2931 { | |
2932 GtkMenuItem *witem = GTK_MENU_ITEM (w); | |
2933 GtkWidget *sub; | |
2934 | |
2935 if (cur->button_type != BUTTON_TYPE_NONE || | |
2936 xg_separator_p (cur->name)) | |
2937 break; | |
2938 | |
2939 xg_update_menu_item (cur, w, select_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); | |
2940 | |
2941 sub = gtk_menu_item_get_submenu (witem); | |
2942 if (sub && ! cur->contents) | |
2943 { | |
2944 /* Not a submenu anymore. */ | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2945 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (sub)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
2946 remove_submenu (witem); |
49323 | 2947 gtk_widget_destroy (sub); |
2948 } | |
2949 else if (cur->contents) | |
2950 { | |
2951 GtkWidget *nsub; | |
2952 | |
2953 nsub = xg_update_submenu (sub, f, cur->contents, | |
2954 select_cb, deactivate_cb, | |
2955 highlight_cb, cl_data); | |
2956 | |
2957 /* If this item just became a submenu, we must set it. */ | |
2958 if (nsub != sub) | |
2959 gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (witem, nsub); | |
2960 } | |
2961 } | |
2962 else | |
2963 { | |
2964 /* Structural difference. Remove everything from here and down | |
2965 in SUBMENU. */ | |
2966 break; | |
2967 } | |
2968 } | |
2969 | |
2970 /* Remove widgets from first structual change. */ | |
2971 if (iter) | |
2972 { | |
2973 /* If we are adding new menu items below, we must remove from | |
2974 first radio button so that radio groups become correct. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2975 if (cur && first_radio) xg_destroy_widgets (first_radio); |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
2976 else xg_destroy_widgets (iter); |
49323 | 2977 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2978 |
49323 | 2979 if (cur) |
2980 { | |
2981 /* More items added. Create them. */ | |
2982 newsub = create_menus (cur, | |
2983 f, | |
2984 select_cb, | |
2985 deactivate_cb, | |
2986 highlight_cb, | |
2987 0, | |
2988 0, | |
2989 ! has_tearoff_p, | |
2990 submenu, | |
2991 cl_data, | |
2992 0); | |
2993 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
2994 |
49572 | 2995 if (list) g_list_free (list); |
2996 | |
49323 | 2997 return newsub; |
2998 } | |
2999 | |
3000 /* Update the MENUBAR. | |
3001 F is the frame the menu bar belongs to. | |
3002 VAL describes the contents of the menu bar. | |
3003 If DEEP_P is non-zero, rebuild all but the top level menu names in | |
3004 the MENUBAR. If DEEP_P is zero, just rebuild the names in the menubar. | |
3005 SELECT_CB is the callback to use when a menu item is selected. | |
3006 DEACTIVATE_CB is the callback to use when a sub menu is not shown anymore. | |
3007 HIGHLIGHT_CB is the callback to call when entering/leaving menu items. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3008 |
49323 | 3009 void |
109364
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
3010 xg_modify_menubar_widgets (GtkWidget *menubar, FRAME_PTR f, widget_value *val, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
3011 int deep_p, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
3012 GCallback select_cb, GCallback deactivate_cb, |
89a16701cde1
Convert old-style definitions
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
109141
diff
changeset
|
3013 GCallback highlight_cb) |
49323 | 3014 { |
3015 xg_menu_cb_data *cl_data; | |
3016 GList *list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (menubar)); | |
3017 | |
3018 if (! list) return; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3019 |
49323 | 3020 cl_data = (xg_menu_cb_data*) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (menubar), |
3021 XG_FRAME_DATA); | |
3022 | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
3023 xg_update_menubar (menubar, f, &list, list, 0, val->contents, |
96971
8a07ea5be91d
(xg_get_font_name): Cast w to GTK_FONT_SELECTION_DIALOG.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
96774
diff
changeset
|
3024 select_cb, deactivate_cb, highlight_cb, cl_data); |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
3025 |
64783
0975467abc17
* gtkutil.c (xg_modify_menubar_widgets): Remove semicolon that
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
64770
diff
changeset
|
3026 if (deep_p) |
49323 | 3027 { |
3028 widget_value *cur; | |
3029 | |
3030 /* Update all sub menus. | |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
3031 We must keep the submenus (GTK menu item widgets) since the |
49323 | 3032 X Window in the XEvent that activates the menu are those widgets. */ |
3033 | |
3034 /* Update cl_data, menu_item things in F may have changed. */ | |
3035 update_cl_data (cl_data, f, highlight_cb); | |
3036 | |
3037 for (cur = val->contents; cur; cur = cur->next) | |
3038 { | |
49572 | 3039 GList *iter; |
49323 | 3040 GtkWidget *sub = 0; |
3041 GtkWidget *newsub; | |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3042 GtkMenuItem *witem = 0; |
49323 | 3043 |
3044 /* Find sub menu that corresponds to val and update it. */ | |
3045 for (iter = list ; iter; iter = g_list_next (iter)) | |
3046 { | |
3047 witem = GTK_MENU_ITEM (iter->data); | |
3048 if (xg_item_label_same_p (witem, cur->name)) | |
3049 { | |
3050 sub = gtk_menu_item_get_submenu (witem); | |
3051 break; | |
3052 } | |
3053 } | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3054 |
49323 | 3055 newsub = xg_update_submenu (sub, |
3056 f, | |
3057 cur->contents, | |
3058 select_cb, | |
3059 deactivate_cb, | |
3060 highlight_cb, | |
3061 cl_data); | |
3062 /* sub may still be NULL. If we just updated non deep and added | |
3063 a new menu bar item, it has no sub menu yet. So we set the | |
3064 newly created sub menu under witem. */ | |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3065 if (newsub != sub && witem != 0) |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3066 { |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3067 xg_set_screen (newsub, f); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3068 gtk_menu_item_set_submenu (witem, newsub); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3069 } |
49323 | 3070 } |
3071 } | |
3072 | |
49572 | 3073 g_list_free (list); |
49323 | 3074 gtk_widget_show_all (menubar); |
3075 } | |
3076 | |
111746 | 3077 /* Callback called when the menu bar W is mapped. |
3078 Used to find the height of the menu bar if we didn't get it | |
3079 after showing the widget. */ | |
3080 | |
3081 static void | |
3082 menubar_map_cb (GtkWidget *w, gpointer user_data) | |
3083 { | |
3084 GtkRequisition req; | |
3085 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) user_data; | |
3086 gtk_widget_size_request (w, &req); | |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3087 if (FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) != req.height) |
111746 | 3088 { |
3089 FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; | |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3090 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
111746 | 3091 } |
3092 } | |
3093 | |
49323 | 3094 /* Recompute all the widgets of frame F, when the menu bar has been |
3095 changed. Value is non-zero if widgets were updated. */ | |
3096 | |
3097 int | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3098 xg_update_frame_menubar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 3099 { |
3100 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
3101 GtkRequisition req; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3102 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3103 if (!x->menubar_widget || gtk_widget_get_mapped (x->menubar_widget)) |
49323 | 3104 return 0; |
3105 | |
106012
fae53e3bfda0
gtkutil.c (xg_update_frame_menubar): Do nothing if menubar already has a parent.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105959
diff
changeset
|
3106 if (x->menubar_widget && gtk_widget_get_parent (x->menubar_widget)) |
fae53e3bfda0
gtkutil.c (xg_update_frame_menubar): Do nothing if menubar already has a parent.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105959
diff
changeset
|
3107 return 0; /* Already done this, happens for frames created invisible. */ |
fae53e3bfda0
gtkutil.c (xg_update_frame_menubar): Do nothing if menubar already has a parent.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105959
diff
changeset
|
3108 |
49323 | 3109 BLOCK_INPUT; |
3110 | |
3111 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (x->vbox_widget), x->menubar_widget, | |
3112 FALSE, FALSE, 0); | |
3113 gtk_box_reorder_child (GTK_BOX (x->vbox_widget), x->menubar_widget, 0); | |
3114 | |
111746 | 3115 g_signal_connect (x->menubar_widget, "map", G_CALLBACK (menubar_map_cb), f); |
49323 | 3116 gtk_widget_show_all (x->menubar_widget); |
3117 gtk_widget_size_request (x->menubar_widget, &req); | |
111779 | 3118 |
111746 | 3119 /* If menu bar doesn't know its height yet, cheat a little so the frame |
3120 doesn't jump so much when resized later in menubar_map_cb. */ | |
3121 if (req.height == 0) | |
3122 req.height = 23; | |
3123 | |
3124 if (FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) != req.height) | |
3125 { | |
3126 FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; | |
111779 | 3127 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
111746 | 3128 } |
49323 | 3129 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
50106
5675d6a0080c
(xg_update_frame_menubar): Add missing return value.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
50099
diff
changeset
|
3130 |
5675d6a0080c
(xg_update_frame_menubar): Add missing return value.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
50099
diff
changeset
|
3131 return 1; |
49323 | 3132 } |
3133 | |
3134 /* Get rid of the menu bar of frame F, and free its storage. | |
3135 This is used when deleting a frame, and when turning off the menu bar. */ | |
3136 | |
3137 void | |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3138 free_frame_menubar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 3139 { |
3140 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
3141 | |
3142 if (x->menubar_widget) | |
3143 { | |
3144 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
3145 | |
3146 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->vbox_widget), x->menubar_widget); | |
3147 /* The menubar and its children shall be deleted when removed from | |
3148 the container. */ | |
3149 x->menubar_widget = 0; | |
3150 FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) = 0; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3151 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 3152 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
3153 } | |
3154 } | |
3155 | |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3156 int |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3157 xg_event_is_for_menubar (FRAME_PTR f, XEvent *event) |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3158 { |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3159 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
109332
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3160 GList *iter; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3161 GdkRectangle rec; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3162 GList *list; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3163 GdkDisplay *gdpy; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3164 GdkWindow *gw; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3165 GdkEvent gevent; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3166 GtkWidget *gwdesc; |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3167 |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3168 if (! x->menubar_widget) return 0; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3169 |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3170 if (! (event->xbutton.x >= 0 |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3171 && event->xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3172 && event->xbutton.y >= 0 |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3173 && event->xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3174 && event->xbutton.same_screen)) |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3175 return 0; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3176 |
109332
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3177 gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3178 gw = gdk_xid_table_lookup_for_display (gdpy, event->xbutton.window); |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3179 if (! gw) return 0; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3180 gevent.any.window = gw; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3181 gwdesc = gtk_get_event_widget (&gevent); |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3182 if (! gwdesc) return 0; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3183 if (! GTK_IS_MENU_BAR (gwdesc) |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3184 && ! GTK_IS_MENU_ITEM (gwdesc) |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3185 && ! gtk_widget_is_ancestor (x->menubar_widget, gwdesc)) |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3186 return 0; |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3187 |
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3188 list = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (x->menubar_widget)); |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3189 if (! list) return 0; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3190 rec.x = event->xbutton.x; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3191 rec.y = event->xbutton.y; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3192 rec.width = 1; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3193 rec.height = 1; |
109332
507549811e3e
* gtkutil.c (xg_event_is_for_menubar): Also check that event window
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109327
diff
changeset
|
3194 |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3195 for (iter = list ; iter; iter = g_list_next (iter)) |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3196 { |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3197 GtkWidget *w = GTK_WIDGET (iter->data); |
109454
514fed5c0ded
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_resized): GTK_IS_MAPPED => gtk_widget_get_mapped, for Gtk 3.0
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109452
diff
changeset
|
3198 if (gtk_widget_get_mapped (w) && gtk_widget_intersect (w, &rec, NULL)) |
109327
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3199 break; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3200 } |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3201 g_list_free (list); |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3202 return iter == 0 ? 0 : 1; |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3203 } |
60266cf487b0
Fix menus as per bug 6499 and 6608.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107219
diff
changeset
|
3204 |
49323 | 3205 |
3206 | |
3207 /*********************************************************************** | |
3208 Scroll bar functions | |
3209 ***********************************************************************/ | |
3210 | |
3211 | |
3212 /* Setting scroll bar values invokes the callback. Use this variable | |
3213 to indicate that callback should do nothing. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3214 |
49323 | 3215 int xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar; |
3216 | |
86161
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3217 /* Xlib's `Window' fits in 32 bits. But we want to store pointers, and they |
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3218 may be larger than 32 bits. Keep a mapping from integer index to widget |
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3219 pointers to get around the 32 bit limitation. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3220 |
49323 | 3221 static struct |
3222 { | |
3223 GtkWidget **widgets; | |
3224 int max_size; | |
3225 int used; | |
49419
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
3226 } id_to_widget; |
49323 | 3227 |
3228 /* Grow this much every time we need to allocate more */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3229 |
49323 | 3230 #define ID_TO_WIDGET_INCR 32 |
3231 | |
3232 /* Store the widget pointer W in id_to_widget and return the integer index. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3233 |
49323 | 3234 static int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3235 xg_store_widget_in_map (GtkWidget *w) |
49323 | 3236 { |
3237 int i; | |
3238 | |
3239 if (id_to_widget.max_size == id_to_widget.used) | |
3240 { | |
3241 int new_size = id_to_widget.max_size + ID_TO_WIDGET_INCR; | |
3242 | |
3243 id_to_widget.widgets = xrealloc (id_to_widget.widgets, | |
3244 sizeof (GtkWidget *)*new_size); | |
3245 | |
3246 for (i = id_to_widget.max_size; i < new_size; ++i) | |
3247 id_to_widget.widgets[i] = 0; | |
3248 id_to_widget.max_size = new_size; | |
3249 } | |
3250 | |
3251 /* Just loop over the array and find a free place. After all, | |
3252 how many scroll bars are we creating? Should be a small number. | |
3253 The check above guarantees we will find a free place. */ | |
3254 for (i = 0; i < id_to_widget.max_size; ++i) | |
3255 { | |
3256 if (! id_to_widget.widgets[i]) | |
3257 { | |
3258 id_to_widget.widgets[i] = w; | |
3259 ++id_to_widget.used; | |
3260 | |
3261 return i; | |
3262 } | |
3263 } | |
3264 | |
3265 /* Should never end up here */ | |
3266 abort (); | |
3267 } | |
3268 | |
3269 /* Remove pointer at IDX from id_to_widget. | |
3270 Called when scroll bar is destroyed. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3271 |
49323 | 3272 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3273 xg_remove_widget_from_map (int idx) |
49323 | 3274 { |
3275 if (idx < id_to_widget.max_size && id_to_widget.widgets[idx] != 0) | |
3276 { | |
3277 id_to_widget.widgets[idx] = 0; | |
3278 --id_to_widget.used; | |
3279 } | |
3280 } | |
3281 | |
3282 /* Get the widget pointer at IDX from id_to_widget. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3283 |
49323 | 3284 static GtkWidget * |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3285 xg_get_widget_from_map (int idx) |
49323 | 3286 { |
3287 if (idx < id_to_widget.max_size && id_to_widget.widgets[idx] != 0) | |
3288 return id_to_widget.widgets[idx]; | |
3289 | |
3290 return 0; | |
3291 } | |
3292 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3293 /* Return the scrollbar id for X Window WID on display DPY. |
50063 | 3294 Return -1 if WID not in id_to_widget. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3295 |
50063 | 3296 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3297 xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (Display *dpy, Window wid) |
50063 | 3298 { |
3299 int idx; | |
3300 GtkWidget *w; | |
3301 | |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3302 w = xg_win_to_widget (dpy, wid); |
50063 | 3303 |
3304 if (w) | |
3305 { | |
3306 for (idx = 0; idx < id_to_widget.max_size; ++idx) | |
3307 if (id_to_widget.widgets[idx] == w) | |
3308 return idx; | |
3309 } | |
3310 | |
3311 return -1; | |
3312 } | |
3313 | |
49323 | 3314 /* Callback invoked when scroll bar WIDGET is destroyed. |
3315 DATA is the index into id_to_widget for WIDGET. | |
50129
d0142038feaa
Reduce flicker in GTK scrollbars.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50112
diff
changeset
|
3316 We free pointer to last scroll bar values here and remove the index. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3317 |
49323 | 3318 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3319 xg_gtk_scroll_destroy (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer data) |
49323 | 3320 { |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3321 int id = (int) (EMACS_INT) data; /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
49323 | 3322 xg_remove_widget_from_map (id); |
3323 } | |
3324 | |
3325 /* Create a scroll bar widget for frame F. Store the scroll bar | |
3326 in BAR. | |
3327 SCROLL_CALLBACK is the callback to invoke when the value of the | |
3328 bar changes. | |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3329 END_CALLBACK is the callback to invoke when scrolling ends. |
49323 | 3330 SCROLL_BAR_NAME is the name we use for the scroll bar. Can be used |
3331 to set resources for the widget. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3332 |
49323 | 3333 void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3334 xg_create_scroll_bar (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3335 struct scroll_bar *bar, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3336 GCallback scroll_callback, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3337 GCallback end_callback, |
109717
8949aad5e992
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109668
diff
changeset
|
3338 const char *scroll_bar_name) |
49323 | 3339 { |
3340 GtkWidget *wscroll; | |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3341 GtkWidget *webox; |
49323 | 3342 GtkObject *vadj; |
3343 int scroll_id; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3344 |
49323 | 3345 /* Page, step increment values are not so important here, they |
3346 will be corrected in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb. */ | |
3347 vadj = gtk_adjustment_new (XG_SB_MIN, XG_SB_MIN, XG_SB_MAX, | |
3348 0.1, 0.1, 0.1); | |
3349 | |
3350 wscroll = gtk_vscrollbar_new (GTK_ADJUSTMENT (vadj)); | |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3351 webox = gtk_event_box_new (); |
49323 | 3352 gtk_widget_set_name (wscroll, scroll_bar_name); |
3353 gtk_range_set_update_policy (GTK_RANGE (wscroll), GTK_UPDATE_CONTINUOUS); | |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3354 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wscroll), XG_FRAME_DATA, (gpointer)f); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3355 |
49323 | 3356 scroll_id = xg_store_widget_in_map (wscroll); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3357 |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3358 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
49323 | 3359 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wscroll), |
3360 "destroy", | |
3361 G_CALLBACK (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy), | |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3362 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) scroll_id); |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3363 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wscroll), |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3364 "change-value", |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3365 scroll_callback, |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3366 (gpointer) bar); |
106549
3acd32c3e0ac
gtkutil.c: Scroll bar thumb not updated properly (bug #5177).
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106512
diff
changeset
|
3367 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wscroll), |
3acd32c3e0ac
gtkutil.c: Scroll bar thumb not updated properly (bug #5177).
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106512
diff
changeset
|
3368 "button-release-event", |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3369 end_callback, |
106549
3acd32c3e0ac
gtkutil.c: Scroll bar thumb not updated properly (bug #5177).
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106512
diff
changeset
|
3370 (gpointer) bar); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3371 |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3372 /* The scroll bar widget does not draw on a window of its own. Instead |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3373 it draws on the parent window, in this case the edit widget. So |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3374 whenever the edit widget is cleared, the scroll bar needs to redraw |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3375 also, which causes flicker. Put an event box between the edit widget |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3376 and the scroll bar, so the scroll bar instead draws itself on the |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3377 event box window. */ |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3378 gtk_fixed_put (GTK_FIXED (f->output_data.x->edit_widget), webox, -1, -1); |
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3379 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (webox), wscroll); |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
3380 |
49323 | 3381 |
3382 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. */ | |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3383 xg_set_cursor (webox, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->xg_cursor); |
49323 | 3384 |
86161
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3385 bar->x_window = scroll_id; |
49323 | 3386 } |
3387 | |
3388 /* Remove the scroll bar represented by SCROLLBAR_ID from the frame F. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3389 |
49323 | 3390 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3391 xg_remove_scroll_bar (FRAME_PTR f, int scrollbar_id) |
49323 | 3392 { |
3393 GtkWidget *w = xg_get_widget_from_map (scrollbar_id); | |
3394 if (w) | |
3395 { | |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3396 GtkWidget *wparent = gtk_widget_get_parent (w); |
49323 | 3397 gtk_widget_destroy (w); |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3398 gtk_widget_destroy (wparent); |
49323 | 3399 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
3400 } | |
3401 } | |
3402 | |
3403 /* Update the position of the vertical scroll bar represented by SCROLLBAR_ID | |
3404 in frame F. | |
3405 TOP/LEFT are the new pixel positions where the bar shall appear. | |
3406 WIDTH, HEIGHT is the size in pixels the bar shall have. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3407 |
49323 | 3408 void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3409 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (FRAME_PTR f, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3410 int scrollbar_id, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3411 int top, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3412 int left, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3413 int width, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3414 int height) |
49323 | 3415 { |
49572 | 3416 |
3417 GtkWidget *wscroll = xg_get_widget_from_map (scrollbar_id); | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3418 |
49572 | 3419 if (wscroll) |
3420 { | |
50177
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3421 GtkWidget *wfixed = f->output_data.x->edit_widget; |
57597
754a6433f048
* gtkutil.c (xg_frame_cleared, xg_fixed_handle_expose,
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57575
diff
changeset
|
3422 GtkWidget *wparent = gtk_widget_get_parent (wscroll); |
109040
98796fa1a7f8
src/gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Avoid C99 mid-block variable declaration.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
109037
diff
changeset
|
3423 gint msl; |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3424 |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3425 /* Clear out old position. */ |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3426 int oldx = -1, oldy = -1, oldw, oldh; |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3427 if (gtk_widget_get_parent (wparent) == wfixed) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3428 { |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3429 gtk_container_child_get (GTK_CONTAINER (wfixed), wparent, |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3430 "x", &oldx, "y", &oldy, NULL); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3431 gtk_widget_get_size_request (wscroll, &oldw, &oldh); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3432 } |
55342
44d086f5e08a
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call XClearWindow to clear
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
53275
diff
changeset
|
3433 |
44d086f5e08a
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call XClearWindow to clear
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
53275
diff
changeset
|
3434 /* Move and resize to new values. */ |
60553
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3435 gtk_fixed_move (GTK_FIXED (wfixed), wparent, left, top); |
109037
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3436 gtk_widget_style_get (wscroll, "min-slider-length", &msl, NULL); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3437 if (msl > height) |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3438 { |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3439 /* No room. Hide scroll bar as some themes output a warning if |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3440 the height is less than the min size. */ |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3441 gtk_widget_hide (wparent); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3442 gtk_widget_hide (wscroll); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3443 } |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3444 else |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3445 { |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3446 gtk_widget_show_all (wparent); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3447 gtk_widget_set_size_request (wscroll, width, height); |
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3448 } |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3449 gtk_widget_queue_draw (wfixed); |
60553
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3450 gdk_window_process_all_updates (); |
109037
3e9a832a5533
Hide scroll bar when window is too small to avoid Gtk+ warning.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108315
diff
changeset
|
3451 if (oldx != -1 && oldw > 0 && oldh > 0) |
106720
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3452 { |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3453 /* Clear under old scroll bar position. This must be done after |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3454 the gtk_widget_queue_draw and gdk_window_process_all_updates |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3455 above. */ |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3456 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3457 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3458 oldx, oldy, oldw, oldh, 0); |
3db7e57ee4e9
Handle change of internal-border width when maximized.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106559
diff
changeset
|
3459 } |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3460 |
60553
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3461 /* GTK does not redraw until the main loop is entered again, but |
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3462 if there are no X events pending we will not enter it. So we sync |
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3463 here to get some events. */ |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3464 |
60553
5ace6337c8fa
* gtkutil.c (xg_update_scrollbar_pos): Call x_sync so that the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
60291
diff
changeset
|
3465 x_sync (f); |
49572 | 3466 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f); |
3467 cancel_mouse_face (f); | |
3468 } | |
49323 | 3469 } |
3470 | |
3471 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently | |
3472 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3473 |
49323 | 3474 void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3475 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3476 int portion, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3477 int position, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3478 int whole) |
49323 | 3479 { |
86161
3408ab8b4152
* xterm.h (struct scroll_bar): Only use Lisp_Object for lisp data.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
85938
diff
changeset
|
3480 GtkWidget *wscroll = xg_get_widget_from_map (bar->x_window); |
49323 | 3481 |
3482 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window))); | |
3483 | |
50177
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3484 if (wscroll && NILP (bar->dragging)) |
49323 | 3485 { |
3486 GtkAdjustment *adj; | |
3487 gdouble shown; | |
3488 gdouble top; | |
3489 int size, value; | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3490 int new_step; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3491 int changed = 0; |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3492 |
49323 | 3493 adj = gtk_range_get_adjustment (GTK_RANGE (wscroll)); |
3494 | |
50177
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3495 /* We do the same as for MOTIF in xterm.c, assume 30 chars per line |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3496 rather than the real portion value. This makes the thumb less likely |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3497 to resize and that looks better. */ |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
3498 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30; |
50177
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3499 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole. |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3500 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */ |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3501 whole += portion; |
297925dd73b1
New approach to scrolling and scroll bars for better redraw and smoother
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50130
diff
changeset
|
3502 |
49323 | 3503 if (whole <= 0) |
3504 top = 0, shown = 1; | |
3505 else | |
3506 { | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3507 top = (gdouble) position / whole; |
49323 | 3508 shown = (gdouble) portion / whole; |
3509 } | |
3510 | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3511 size = shown * XG_SB_RANGE; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3512 size = min (size, XG_SB_RANGE); |
49323 | 3513 size = max (size, 1); |
3514 | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3515 value = top * XG_SB_RANGE; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3516 value = min (value, XG_SB_MAX - size); |
49323 | 3517 value = max (value, XG_SB_MIN); |
3518 | |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3519 /* Assume all lines are of equal size. */ |
51211
28ea05de2dc5
Make (many) trivial substitutions for renamed and
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
50778
diff
changeset
|
3520 new_step = size / max (1, FRAME_LINES (f)); |
50178
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3521 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3522 if ((int) gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj) != size |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3523 || (int) gtk_adjustment_get_step_increment (adj) != new_step) |
50178
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3524 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3525 gtk_adjustment_set_page_size (adj, size); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3526 gtk_adjustment_set_step_increment (adj, new_step); |
50178
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3527 /* Assume a page increment is about 95% of the page size */ |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3528 gtk_adjustment_set_page_increment (adj,(int) (0.95*size)); |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3529 changed = 1; |
50178
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3530 } |
61194aef8668
* gtkutil.c (xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb): Check if new values
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50177
diff
changeset
|
3531 |
50270
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3532 if (changed || (int) gtk_range_get_value (GTK_RANGE (wscroll)) != value) |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3533 { |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3534 BLOCK_INPUT; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3535 |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3536 /* gtk_range_set_value invokes the callback. Set |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3537 ignore_gtk_scrollbar to make the callback do nothing */ |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3538 xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar = 1; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3539 |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3540 if ((int) gtk_range_get_value (GTK_RANGE (wscroll)) != value) |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3541 gtk_range_set_value (GTK_RANGE (wscroll), (gdouble)value); |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3542 else if (changed) |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3543 gtk_adjustment_changed (adj); |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3544 |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3545 xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar = 0; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3546 |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3547 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
fa50953c02dc
Finally (?) fix flicker in scroll bar.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50192
diff
changeset
|
3548 } |
49323 | 3549 } |
3550 } | |
3551 | |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3552 /* Return non-zero if EVENT is for a scroll bar in frame F. |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3553 When the same X window is used for several Gtk+ widgets, we cannot |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3554 say for sure based on the X window alone if an event is for the |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3555 frame. This function does additional checks. |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3556 |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3557 Return non-zero if the event is for a scroll bar, zero otherwise. */ |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3558 |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3559 int |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3560 xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (FRAME_PTR f, XEvent *event) |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3561 { |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3562 int retval = 0; |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3563 |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3564 if (f && event->type == ButtonPress && event->xbutton.button < 4) |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3565 { |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3566 /* Check if press occurred outside the edit widget. */ |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3567 GdkDisplay *gdpy = gdk_x11_lookup_xdisplay (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)); |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3568 retval = gdk_display_get_window_at_pointer (gdpy, NULL, NULL) |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3569 != gtk_widget_get_window (f->output_data.x->edit_widget); |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3570 } |
106559
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3571 else if (f |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3572 && ((event->type == ButtonRelease && event->xbutton.button < 4) |
bac7488df503
Bug 5177: Scroll bar thumb did not move when scrolling with mouse wheel.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
106549
diff
changeset
|
3573 || event->type == MotionNotify)) |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3574 { |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3575 /* If we are releasing or moving the scroll bar, it has the grab. */ |
107997
d94009e7a0cc
gtkutils.c (xg_event_is_for_scrollbar): Check if grabbed widget is a scrollbar.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107891
diff
changeset
|
3576 GtkWidget *w = gtk_grab_get_current (); |
d94009e7a0cc
gtkutils.c (xg_event_is_for_scrollbar): Check if grabbed widget is a scrollbar.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107891
diff
changeset
|
3577 retval = w != 0 && GTK_IS_SCROLLBAR (w); |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3578 } |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3579 |
105880
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3580 return retval; |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3581 } |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3582 |
5910e0380daf
Fix bug #4870, issues 3 and 4.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
105693
diff
changeset
|
3583 |
49323 | 3584 |
3585 /*********************************************************************** | |
3586 Tool bar functions | |
3587 ***********************************************************************/ | |
3588 /* The key for the data we put in the GtkImage widgets. The data is | |
3589 the image used by Emacs. We use this to see if we need to update | |
3590 the GtkImage with a new image. */ | |
3591 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA "emacs-tool-bar-image" | |
3592 | |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3593 /* The key for storing the latest modifiers so the activate callback can |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3594 get them. */ |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3595 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_LAST_MODIFIER "emacs-tool-bar-modifier" |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3596 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3597 /* The key for storing the button widget in its proxy menu item. */ |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3598 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_PROXY_BUTTON "emacs-tool-bar-proxy-button" |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3599 |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3600 /* The key for the data we put in the GtkImage widgets. The data is |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3601 the stock name used by Emacs. We use this to see if we need to update |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3602 the GtkImage with a new image. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3603 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME "emacs-tool-bar-stock-name" |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3604 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3605 /* As above, but this is used for named theme widgets, as opposed to |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3606 stock items. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3607 #define XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME "emacs-tool-bar-icon-name" |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3608 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3609 /* Callback function invoked when a tool bar item is pressed. |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3610 W is the button widget in the tool bar that got pressed, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3611 CLIENT_DATA is an integer that is the index of the button in the |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3612 tool bar. 0 is the first button. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
3613 |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3614 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3615 xg_tool_bar_button_cb (GtkWidget *widget, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3616 GdkEventButton *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3617 gpointer user_data) |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3618 { |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
3619 /* Casts to avoid warnings when gpointer is 64 bits and int is 32 bits */ |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
3620 gpointer ptr = (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) event->state; |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3621 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_TOOL_BAR_LAST_MODIFIER, ptr); |
68922 | 3622 return FALSE; |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3623 } |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3624 |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3625 |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3626 /* Callback function invoked when a tool bar item is pressed. |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3627 W is the button widget in the tool bar that got pressed, |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3628 CLIENT_DATA is an integer that is the index of the button in the |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3629 tool bar. 0 is the first button. */ |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
3630 |
49323 | 3631 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3632 xg_tool_bar_callback (GtkWidget *w, gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 3633 { |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3634 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3635 int idx = (int) (EMACS_INT) client_data; |
73389
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
3636 int mod = (int) (EMACS_INT) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), |
7b5c0104efb0
* gtkutil.c (get_utf8_string): Remove warnings with casts.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
73066
diff
changeset
|
3637 XG_TOOL_BAR_LAST_MODIFIER); |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3638 |
49323 | 3639 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), XG_FRAME_DATA); |
3640 Lisp_Object key, frame; | |
3641 struct input_event event; | |
51569
e7bd8581e306
(xg_tool_bar_callback): Don't pass uninitialized
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents:
51432
diff
changeset
|
3642 EVENT_INIT (event); |
49323 | 3643 |
3644 if (! f || ! f->n_tool_bar_items || NILP (f->tool_bar_items)) | |
3645 return; | |
3646 | |
3647 idx *= TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
3648 |
49323 | 3649 key = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_KEY); |
3650 XSETFRAME (frame, f); | |
78538
2fcf45c12927
(update_frame_tool_bar): Use -1 as index
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78260
diff
changeset
|
3651 |
2fcf45c12927
(update_frame_tool_bar): Use -1 as index
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78260
diff
changeset
|
3652 /* We generate two events here. The first one is to set the prefix |
2fcf45c12927
(update_frame_tool_bar): Use -1 as index
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78260
diff
changeset
|
3653 to `(tool_bar)', see keyboard.c. */ |
49323 | 3654 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT; |
3655 event.frame_or_window = frame; | |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3656 event.arg = frame; |
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3657 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event); |
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3658 |
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3659 event.kind = TOOL_BAR_EVENT; |
49323 | 3660 event.frame_or_window = frame; |
3661 event.arg = key; | |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3662 /* Convert between the modifier bits GDK uses and the modifier bits |
102549
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3663 Emacs uses. This assumes GDK and X masks are the same, which they are when |
68874
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3664 this is written. */ |
8ccdd5aee32d
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_button_cb): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68651
diff
changeset
|
3665 event.modifiers = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), mod); |
49323 | 3666 kbd_buffer_store_event (&event); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3667 |
102549
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3668 /* Return focus to the frame after we have clicked on a detached |
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3669 tool bar button. */ |
f737bc68655e
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_callback): Set focus back to the frame
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102358
diff
changeset
|
3670 Fx_focus_frame (frame); |
49323 | 3671 } |
3672 | |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3673 /* Callback function invoked when a tool bar item is pressed in a detached |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3674 tool bar or the overflow drop down menu. |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3675 We just call xg_tool_bar_callback. |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3676 W is the menu item widget that got pressed, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3677 CLIENT_DATA is an integer that is the index of the button in the |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3678 tool bar. 0 is the first button. */ |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3679 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3680 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3681 xg_tool_bar_proxy_callback (GtkWidget *w, gpointer client_data) |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3682 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3683 GtkWidget *wbutton = GTK_WIDGET (g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3684 XG_TOOL_BAR_PROXY_BUTTON)); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3685 xg_tool_bar_callback (wbutton, client_data); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3686 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3687 |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3688 |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3689 static gboolean |
109100
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109067
diff
changeset
|
3690 xg_tool_bar_help_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109067
diff
changeset
|
3691 GdkEventCrossing *event, |
2bc9a0c04c87
Remove __P and P_ from .c and .m files and definition of P_
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109067
diff
changeset
|
3692 gpointer client_data); |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3693 |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3694 /* This callback is called when a help is to be shown for an item in |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3695 the detached tool bar when the detached tool bar it is not expanded. */ |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3696 |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3697 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3698 xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3699 GdkEventCrossing *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3700 gpointer client_data) |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3701 { |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3702 GtkWidget *wbutton = GTK_WIDGET (g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3703 XG_TOOL_BAR_PROXY_BUTTON)); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3704 |
106512
471e6932ea09
(xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): Fix missing return.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@linux-m68k.org>
parents:
106186
diff
changeset
|
3705 return xg_tool_bar_help_callback (wbutton, event, client_data); |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3706 } |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3707 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3708 static GtkWidget * |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3709 xg_get_tool_bar_widgets (GtkWidget *vb, GtkWidget **wimage) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3710 { |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3711 GList *clist = gtk_container_get_children (GTK_CONTAINER (vb)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3712 GtkWidget *c1 = (GtkWidget *) clist->data; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3713 GtkWidget *c2 = (GtkWidget *) clist->next->data; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3714 *wimage = GTK_IS_IMAGE (c1) ? c1 : c2; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3715 g_list_free (clist); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3716 return GTK_IS_LABEL (c1) ? c1 : c2; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3717 } |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3718 |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3719 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3720 /* This callback is called when a tool item should create a proxy item, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3721 such as for the overflow menu. Also called when the tool bar is detached. |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3722 If we don't create a proxy menu item, the detached tool bar will be |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3723 blank. */ |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3724 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3725 static gboolean |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
3726 xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy (GtkToolItem *toolitem, gpointer user_data) |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3727 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3728 GtkWidget *weventbox = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (toolitem)); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3729 GtkButton *wbutton = GTK_BUTTON (gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (weventbox))); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3730 GtkWidget *vb = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (wbutton)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3731 GtkWidget *c1; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3732 GtkLabel *wlbl = GTK_LABEL (xg_get_tool_bar_widgets (vb, &c1)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3733 GtkImage *wimage = GTK_IMAGE (c1); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3734 GtkWidget *wmenuitem = gtk_image_menu_item_new_with_label |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
3735 (gtk_label_get_text (wlbl)); |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3736 GtkWidget *wmenuimage; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3737 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3738 |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3739 if (gtk_button_get_use_stock (wbutton)) |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3740 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_stock (gtk_button_get_label (wbutton), |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3741 GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3742 else |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3743 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3744 GtkSettings *settings = gtk_widget_get_settings (GTK_WIDGET (wbutton)); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3745 GtkImageType store_type = gtk_image_get_storage_type (wimage); |
85938
d7e05ac913d8
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
84621
diff
changeset
|
3746 |
110521
1cdff3b101d6
Make sure detached tool bar menu isn't blank.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109332
diff
changeset
|
3747 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (settings), "gtk-menu-images", TRUE, NULL); |
1cdff3b101d6
Make sure detached tool bar menu isn't blank.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109332
diff
changeset
|
3748 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3749 if (store_type == GTK_IMAGE_STOCK) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3750 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3751 gchar *stock_id; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3752 gtk_image_get_stock (wimage, &stock_id, NULL); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3753 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_stock (stock_id, GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3754 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3755 else if (store_type == GTK_IMAGE_ICON_SET) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3756 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3757 GtkIconSet *icon_set; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3758 gtk_image_get_icon_set (wimage, &icon_set, NULL); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3759 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_icon_set (icon_set, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3760 GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3761 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3762 else if (store_type == GTK_IMAGE_PIXBUF) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3763 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3764 gint width, height; |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3765 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3766 if (settings && |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3767 gtk_icon_size_lookup_for_settings (settings, GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3768 &width, &height)) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3769 { |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3770 GdkPixbuf *src_pixbuf, *dest_pixbuf; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3771 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3772 src_pixbuf = gtk_image_get_pixbuf (wimage); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3773 dest_pixbuf = gdk_pixbuf_scale_simple (src_pixbuf, width, height, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3774 GDK_INTERP_BILINEAR); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3775 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3776 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_pixbuf (dest_pixbuf); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3777 } |
79340
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3778 else |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3779 { |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3780 fprintf (stderr, "internal error: GTK_IMAGE_PIXBUF failed\n"); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3781 abort (); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3782 } |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3783 } |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
3784 else if (store_type == GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME) |
79340
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3785 { |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3786 const gchar *icon_name; |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3787 GtkIconSize icon_size; |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3788 |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3789 gtk_image_get_icon_name (wimage, &icon_name, &icon_size); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3790 wmenuimage = gtk_image_new_from_icon_name (icon_name, |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3791 GTK_ICON_SIZE_MENU); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3792 } |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3793 else |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3794 { |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3795 fprintf (stderr, "internal error: store_type is %d\n", store_type); |
7c710af0ae5e
(xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy): Handle GTK_IMAGE_ICON_NAME and
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78809
diff
changeset
|
3796 abort (); |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3797 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3798 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3799 if (wmenuimage) |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3800 gtk_image_menu_item_set_image (GTK_IMAGE_MENU_ITEM (wmenuitem), wmenuimage); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3801 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3802 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenuitem), |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3803 "activate", |
103022
15bf0d8a6099
Make Emacs compile when Gtk+ and -DGTK_DISABLE_DEPRECATED is used.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102705
diff
changeset
|
3804 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_proxy_callback), |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3805 user_data); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3806 |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
3807 |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3808 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wmenuitem), XG_TOOL_BAR_PROXY_BUTTON, |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3809 (gpointer) wbutton); |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3810 gtk_tool_item_set_proxy_menu_item (toolitem, "Emacs toolbar item", wmenuitem); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3811 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (wmenuitem, |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3812 gtk_widget_get_sensitive (GTK_WIDGET (wbutton))); |
103673
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3813 |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3814 /* Use enter/leave notify to show help. We use the events |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3815 rather than the GtkButton specific signals "enter" and |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3816 "leave", so we can have only one callback. The event |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3817 will tell us what kind of event it is. */ |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3818 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenuitem), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3819 "enter-notify-event", |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3820 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3821 user_data); |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3822 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wmenuitem), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3823 "leave-notify-event", |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3824 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback), |
34f3338fd2bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_proxy_help_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103665
diff
changeset
|
3825 user_data); |
75009
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3826 |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3827 return TRUE; |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3828 } |
6ec19c8cca02
(update_frame_tool_bar): Connect create-menu-proxy with
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74990
diff
changeset
|
3829 |
49323 | 3830 /* This callback is called when a tool bar is detached. We must set |
3831 the height of the tool bar to zero when this happens so frame sizes | |
3832 are correctly calculated. | |
3833 WBOX is the handle box widget that enables detach/attach of the tool bar. | |
3834 W is the tool bar widget. | |
3835 CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the frame the tool bar belongs to. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3836 |
49323 | 3837 static void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3838 xg_tool_bar_detach_callback (GtkHandleBox *wbox, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3839 GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3840 gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 3841 { |
3842 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) client_data; | |
68879
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3843 extern int x_gtk_whole_detached_tool_bar; |
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3844 |
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3845 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (w), "show-arrow", !x_gtk_whole_detached_tool_bar, |
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3846 NULL); |
49323 | 3847 |
3848 if (f) | |
3849 { | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3850 GtkRequisition req, req2; |
59420
eb72706060ad
* xterm.h (struct x_output): New member, toolbar_detached.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59411
diff
changeset
|
3851 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->toolbar_detached = 1; |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3852 gtk_widget_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (wbox), &req); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3853 gtk_widget_size_request (w, &req2); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3854 req.width -= req2.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3855 req.height -= req2.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3856 if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3857 FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3858 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3859 FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3860 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3861 FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3862 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3863 FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3864 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 3865 } |
3866 } | |
3867 | |
3868 /* This callback is called when a tool bar is reattached. We must set | |
3869 the height of the tool bar when this happens so frame sizes | |
3870 are correctly calculated. | |
3871 WBOX is the handle box widget that enables detach/attach of the tool bar. | |
3872 W is the tool bar widget. | |
3873 CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the frame the tool bar belongs to. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3874 |
49323 | 3875 static void |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3876 xg_tool_bar_attach_callback (GtkHandleBox *wbox, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3877 GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3878 gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 3879 { |
3880 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) client_data; | |
68879
3249a3dd3284
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback): Set show-arrow to the
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
68874
diff
changeset
|
3881 g_object_set (G_OBJECT (w), "show-arrow", TRUE, NULL); |
49323 | 3882 |
3883 if (f) | |
3884 { | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3885 GtkRequisition req, req2; |
59420
eb72706060ad
* xterm.h (struct x_output): New member, toolbar_detached.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59411
diff
changeset
|
3886 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->toolbar_detached = 0; |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3887 gtk_widget_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (wbox), &req); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3888 gtk_widget_size_request (w, &req2); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3889 req.width += req2.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3890 req.height += req2.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3891 if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3892 FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3893 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3894 FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3895 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3896 FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3897 else if (FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) != 0) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3898 FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3899 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 3900 } |
3901 } | |
3902 | |
3903 /* This callback is called when the mouse enters or leaves a tool bar item. | |
3904 It is used for displaying and hiding the help text. | |
3905 W is the tool bar item, a button. | |
3906 EVENT is either an enter event or leave event. | |
3907 CLIENT_DATA is an integer that is the index of the button in the | |
3908 tool bar. 0 is the first button. | |
3909 | |
3910 Returns FALSE to tell GTK to keep processing this event. */ | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3911 |
49323 | 3912 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3913 xg_tool_bar_help_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3914 GdkEventCrossing *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3915 gpointer client_data) |
49323 | 3916 { |
59411
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3917 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
ecb6689e04bf
* gtkutil.c (xg_gtk_scroll_destroy, xg_create_scroll_bar)
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59102
diff
changeset
|
3918 int idx = (int) (EMACS_INT) client_data; |
49323 | 3919 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (w), XG_FRAME_DATA); |
3920 Lisp_Object help, frame; | |
3921 | |
3922 if (! f || ! f->n_tool_bar_items || NILP (f->tool_bar_items)) | |
50108
a9ff586d3d09
(xg_tool_bar_help_callback): Add missing return value.
Andreas Schwab <schwab@suse.de>
parents:
50106
diff
changeset
|
3923 return FALSE; |
49323 | 3924 |
3925 if (event->type == GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY) | |
3926 { | |
3927 idx *= TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS; | |
3928 help = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_HELP); | |
3929 | |
3930 if (NILP (help)) | |
3931 help = AREF (f->tool_bar_items, idx + TOOL_BAR_ITEM_CAPTION); | |
3932 } | |
3933 else | |
3934 help = Qnil; | |
3935 | |
3936 XSETFRAME (frame, f); | |
3937 kbd_buffer_store_help_event (frame, help); | |
3938 | |
3939 return FALSE; | |
3940 } | |
3941 | |
3942 | |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3943 /* This callback is called when a tool bar item shall be redrawn. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3944 It modifies the expose event so that the GtkImage widget redraws the |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3945 whole image. This to overcome a bug that makes GtkImage draw the image |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3946 in the wrong place when it tries to redraw just a part of the image. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3947 W is the GtkImage to be redrawn. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3948 EVENT is the expose event for W. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3949 CLIENT_DATA is unused. |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3950 |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3951 Returns FALSE to tell GTK to keep processing this event. */ |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3952 |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3953 static gboolean |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3954 xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback (GtkWidget *w, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3955 GdkEventExpose *event, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
3956 gpointer client_data) |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3957 { |
50333
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3958 gint width, height; |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3959 |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3960 gdk_drawable_get_size (event->window, &width, &height); |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3961 |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3962 event->area.x -= width > event->area.width ? width-event->area.width : 0; |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3963 event->area.y -= height > event->area.height ? height-event->area.height : 0; |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3964 |
53069
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3965 event->area.x = max (0, event->area.x); |
1218a42792ea
Implement multiple display handling for GTK.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52981
diff
changeset
|
3966 event->area.y = max (0, event->area.y); |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
3967 |
50333
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3968 event->area.width = max (width, event->area.width); |
60da21fd968b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback): Reduce size
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
50318
diff
changeset
|
3969 event->area.height = max (height, event->area.height); |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
3970 |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3971 return FALSE; |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3972 } |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
3973 |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3974 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_ORIENTABLE_SET_ORIENTATION |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3975 #define toolbar_set_orientation(w, o) \ |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3976 gtk_orientable_set_orientation (GTK_ORIENTABLE (w), o) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3977 #else |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3978 #define toolbar_set_orientation(w, o) \ |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3979 gtk_toolbar_set_orientation (GTK_TOOLBAR (w), o) |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
3980 #endif |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
3981 |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3982 /* Attach a tool bar to frame F. */ |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3983 |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3984 static void |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3985 xg_pack_tool_bar (FRAME_PTR f, Lisp_Object pos) |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3986 { |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
3987 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3988 int into_hbox = EQ (pos, Qleft) || EQ (pos, Qright); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3989 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3990 toolbar_set_orientation (x->toolbar_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3991 into_hbox |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3992 ? GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3993 : GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3994 if (!x->handlebox_widget) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3995 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3996 x->handlebox_widget = gtk_handle_box_new (); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3997 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (x->handlebox_widget), "child-detached", |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3998 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_detach_callback), f); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
3999 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (x->handlebox_widget), "child-attached", |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4000 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_attach_callback), f); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4001 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (x->handlebox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4002 x->toolbar_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4003 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4004 |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
4005 if (into_hbox) |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4006 { |
110389
4fd09e92be41
Put handle on top for vertical toolbar, Bug#7051.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109826
diff
changeset
|
4007 gtk_handle_box_set_handle_position (GTK_HANDLE_BOX (x->handlebox_widget), |
4fd09e92be41
Put handle on top for vertical toolbar, Bug#7051.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109826
diff
changeset
|
4008 GTK_POS_TOP); |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4009 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (x->hbox_widget), x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4010 FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4011 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4012 if (EQ (pos, Qleft)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4013 gtk_box_reorder_child (GTK_BOX (x->hbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4014 x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4015 0); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4016 x->toolbar_in_hbox = 1; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4017 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4018 else |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4019 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4020 int vbox_pos = x->menubar_widget ? 1 : 0; |
110389
4fd09e92be41
Put handle on top for vertical toolbar, Bug#7051.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109826
diff
changeset
|
4021 gtk_handle_box_set_handle_position (GTK_HANDLE_BOX (x->handlebox_widget), |
4fd09e92be41
Put handle on top for vertical toolbar, Bug#7051.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109826
diff
changeset
|
4022 GTK_POS_LEFT); |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4023 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (x->vbox_widget), x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4024 FALSE, FALSE, 0); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4025 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4026 if (EQ (pos, Qtop)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4027 gtk_box_reorder_child (GTK_BOX (x->vbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4028 x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4029 vbox_pos); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4030 x->toolbar_in_hbox = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4031 } |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
4032 } |
50063 | 4033 |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4034 /* Create a tool bar for frame F. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4035 |
49323 | 4036 static void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4037 xg_create_tool_bar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 4038 { |
4039 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
4040 | |
4041 x->toolbar_widget = gtk_toolbar_new (); | |
59420
eb72706060ad
* xterm.h (struct x_output): New member, toolbar_detached.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59411
diff
changeset
|
4042 x->toolbar_detached = 0; |
eb72706060ad
* xterm.h (struct x_output): New member, toolbar_detached.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59411
diff
changeset
|
4043 |
49826
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
4044 gtk_widget_set_name (x->toolbar_widget, "emacs-toolbar"); |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
4045 |
e99f1a981a3b
* gtkutil.c (xg_tool_bar_expose_callback): New function.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49600
diff
changeset
|
4046 gtk_toolbar_set_style (GTK_TOOLBAR (x->toolbar_widget), GTK_TOOLBAR_ICONS); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4047 toolbar_set_orientation (x->toolbar_widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL); |
49323 | 4048 } |
4049 | |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
4050 |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
4051 #define PROP(IDX) AREF (f->tool_bar_items, i * TOOL_BAR_ITEM_NSLOTS + (IDX)) |
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
4052 |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4053 /* Find the right-to-left image named by RTL in the tool bar images for F. |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4054 Returns IMAGE if RTL is not found. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4055 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4056 static Lisp_Object |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4057 find_rtl_image (FRAME_PTR f, Lisp_Object image, Lisp_Object rtl) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4058 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4059 int i; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4060 Lisp_Object file, rtl_name; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4061 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4062 GCPRO2 (file, rtl_name); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4063 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4064 rtl_name = Ffile_name_nondirectory (rtl); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4065 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4066 for (i = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4067 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4068 Lisp_Object rtl_image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
4069 if (!NILP (file = file_for_image (rtl_image))) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4070 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4071 file = call1 (intern ("file-name-sans-extension"), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4072 Ffile_name_nondirectory (file)); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4073 if (EQ (Fequal (file, rtl_name), Qt)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4074 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4075 image = rtl_image; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4076 break; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4077 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4078 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4079 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4080 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4081 return image; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4082 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4083 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4084 static GtkToolItem * |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4085 xg_make_tool_item (FRAME_PTR f, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4086 GtkWidget *wimage, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4087 GtkWidget **wbutton, |
109726
64732fa6188a
Use const char* instead of char*.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109717
diff
changeset
|
4088 const char *label, |
111650
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4089 int i, |
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4090 int vert_only) |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4091 { |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4092 GtkToolItem *ti = gtk_tool_item_new (); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4093 Lisp_Object style = Ftool_bar_get_system_style (); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4094 int both_horiz = EQ (style, Qboth_horiz); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4095 int text_image = EQ (style, Qtext_image_horiz); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
4096 |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4097 GtkWidget *vb = both_horiz || text_image |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4098 ? gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0) : gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4099 GtkWidget *wb = gtk_button_new (); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4100 GtkWidget *weventbox = gtk_event_box_new (); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4101 |
111650
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4102 /* We are not letting Gtk+ alter display on this, we only keep it here |
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4103 so we can get it later in xg_show_toolbar_item. */ |
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4104 gtk_tool_item_set_is_important (ti, !vert_only); |
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4105 |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4106 if (wimage && ! text_image) |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4107 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vb), wimage, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4108 |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4109 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vb), gtk_label_new (label), TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4110 |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4111 if (wimage && text_image) |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4112 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (vb), wimage, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4113 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4114 gtk_button_set_focus_on_click (GTK_BUTTON (wb), FALSE); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4115 gtk_button_set_relief (GTK_BUTTON (wb), GTK_RELIEF_NONE); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4116 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (wb), vb); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4117 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (weventbox), wb); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4118 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (ti), weventbox); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4119 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4120 if (wimage) |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4121 { |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4122 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4123 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (ti), "create-menu-proxy", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4124 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_menu_proxy), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4125 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4126 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4127 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (wb), "clicked", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4128 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_callback), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4129 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4130 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4131 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (weventbox), XG_FRAME_DATA, (gpointer)f); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4132 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4133 /* Catch expose events to overcome an annoying redraw bug, see |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4134 comment for xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4135 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (ti), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4136 "expose-event", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4137 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_item_expose_callback), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4138 0); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4139 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4140 gtk_tool_item_set_homogeneous (ti, FALSE); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4141 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4142 /* Callback to save modifyer mask (Shift/Control, etc). GTK makes |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4143 no distinction based on modifiers in the activate callback, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4144 so we have to do it ourselves. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4145 g_signal_connect (wb, "button-release-event", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4146 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_button_cb), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4147 NULL); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4148 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4149 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wb), XG_FRAME_DATA, (gpointer)f); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
4150 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4151 /* Use enter/leave notify to show help. We use the events |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4152 rather than the GtkButton specific signals "enter" and |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4153 "leave", so we can have only one callback. The event |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4154 will tell us what kind of event it is. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4155 /* The EMACS_INT cast avoids a warning. */ |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4156 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (weventbox), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4157 "enter-notify-event", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4158 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_help_callback), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4159 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4160 g_signal_connect (G_OBJECT (weventbox), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4161 "leave-notify-event", |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4162 G_CALLBACK (xg_tool_bar_help_callback), |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4163 (gpointer) (EMACS_INT) i); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4164 } |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
4165 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4166 if (wbutton) *wbutton = wb; |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4167 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4168 return ti; |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4169 } |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4170 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4171 static void |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4172 xg_show_toolbar_item (GtkToolItem *ti) |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4173 { |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4174 Lisp_Object style = Ftool_bar_get_system_style (); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4175 int both_horiz = EQ (style, Qboth_horiz); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4176 int text_image = EQ (style, Qtext_image_horiz); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4177 |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4178 int horiz = both_horiz || text_image; |
111650
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4179 int vert_only = ! gtk_tool_item_get_is_important (ti); |
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4180 int show_label = ! EQ (style, Qimage) && ! (vert_only && horiz); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4181 int show_image = ! EQ (style, Qtext); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4182 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4183 GtkWidget *weventbox = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (ti)); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4184 GtkWidget *wbutton = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (weventbox)); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4185 GtkWidget *vb = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (wbutton)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4186 GtkWidget *wimage; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4187 GtkWidget *wlbl = xg_get_tool_bar_widgets (vb, &wimage); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4188 GtkWidget *new_box = NULL; |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4189 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4190 if (GTK_IS_VBOX (vb) && horiz) |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4191 new_box = gtk_hbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4192 else if (GTK_IS_HBOX (vb) && !horiz && show_label && show_image) |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4193 new_box = gtk_vbox_new (FALSE, 0); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4194 |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4195 if (!new_box && horiz) |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4196 gtk_box_reorder_child (GTK_BOX (vb), wlbl, text_image ? 0 : 1); |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4197 else if (new_box) |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4198 { |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4199 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (wimage)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4200 g_object_ref (G_OBJECT (wlbl)); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4201 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (vb), wimage); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4202 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (vb), wlbl); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4203 gtk_widget_destroy (GTK_WIDGET (vb)); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4204 if (! text_image) |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4205 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (new_box), wimage, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4206 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (new_box), wlbl, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
109566
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4207 if (text_image) |
d03bc4a3fced
Add tool bar style text-image-horiz (text to the left of the image).
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109454
diff
changeset
|
4208 gtk_box_pack_start (GTK_BOX (new_box), wimage, TRUE, TRUE, 0); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4209 gtk_container_add (GTK_CONTAINER (wbutton), new_box); |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4210 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (wimage)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4211 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (wlbl)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4212 vb = new_box; |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4213 } |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4214 |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4215 if (show_label) gtk_widget_show (wlbl); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4216 else gtk_widget_hide (wlbl); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4217 if (show_image) gtk_widget_show (wimage); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4218 else gtk_widget_hide (wimage); |
108315
8bb62bdbd80a
Fix bug #6139, text is briefly shown in tool bar on startup.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
108082
diff
changeset
|
4219 gtk_widget_show (GTK_WIDGET (weventbox)); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4220 gtk_widget_show (GTK_WIDGET (vb)); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4221 gtk_widget_show (GTK_WIDGET (wbutton)); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4222 gtk_widget_show (GTK_WIDGET (ti)); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4223 } |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4224 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4225 static int |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4226 xg_update_tool_bar_sizes (FRAME_PTR f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4227 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4228 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4229 GtkRequisition req; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4230 int nl = 0, nr = 0, nt = 0, nb = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4231 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4232 gtk_widget_size_request (GTK_WIDGET (x->handlebox_widget), &req); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4233 if (x->toolbar_in_hbox) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4234 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4235 int pos; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4236 gtk_container_child_get (GTK_CONTAINER (x->hbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4237 x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4238 "position", &pos, NULL); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4239 if (pos == 0) nl = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4240 else nr = req.width; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4241 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4242 else |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4243 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4244 int pos; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4245 gtk_container_child_get (GTK_CONTAINER (x->vbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4246 x->handlebox_widget, |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4247 "position", &pos, NULL); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4248 if (pos == 0 || (pos == 1 && x->menubar_widget)) nt = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4249 else nb = req.height; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4250 } |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
4251 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4252 if (nl != FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4253 || nr != FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4254 || nt != FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4255 || nb != FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4256 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4257 FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4258 = FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4259 FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) = nl; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4260 FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = nr; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4261 FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = nt; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4262 FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = nb; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4263 return 1; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4264 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4265 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4266 return 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4267 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4268 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4269 |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4270 /* Update the tool bar for frame F. Add new buttons and remove old. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4271 |
49323 | 4272 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4273 update_frame_tool_bar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 4274 { |
4275 int i; | |
4276 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
75576
e852dba095f9
(update_frame_tool_bar): Initialize h/vmargin to 0.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75417
diff
changeset
|
4277 int hmargin = 0, vmargin = 0; |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4278 GtkToolbar *wtoolbar; |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4279 GtkToolItem *ti; |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4280 GtkTextDirection dir; |
92366
39b38c867ca4
(xg_resize_outer_widget): Only do one of set_geometry or
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
91632
diff
changeset
|
4281 int pack_tool_bar = x->handlebox_widget == NULL; |
49323 | 4282 |
4283 if (! FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f)) | |
4284 return; | |
4285 | |
4286 BLOCK_INPUT; | |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
4287 |
59084
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4288 if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4289 && XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin) > 0) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4290 { |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4291 hmargin = XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4292 vmargin = XFASTINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4293 } |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4294 else if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4295 { |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4296 if (INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4297 && XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) > 0) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4298 hmargin = XFASTINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4299 |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4300 if (INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4301 && XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)) > 0) |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4302 vmargin = XFASTINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4303 } |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4304 |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4305 /* The natural size (i.e. when GTK uses 0 as margin) looks best, |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4306 so take DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN to mean "default for GTK", |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4307 i.e. zero. This means that margins less than |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4308 DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN has no effect. */ |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4309 hmargin = max (0, hmargin - DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4310 vmargin = max (0, vmargin - DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_MARGIN); |
60185
391f44959566
(xg_create_frame_widgets): UNBLOCK_INPUT on error.
Kim F. Storm <storm@cua.dk>
parents:
59913
diff
changeset
|
4311 |
49323 | 4312 if (! x->toolbar_widget) |
4313 xg_create_tool_bar (f); | |
4314 | |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4315 wtoolbar = GTK_TOOLBAR (x->toolbar_widget); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4316 dir = gtk_widget_get_direction (GTK_WIDGET (wtoolbar)); |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
4317 |
49323 | 4318 for (i = 0; i < f->n_tool_bar_items; ++i) |
4319 { | |
4320 int enabled_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_ENABLED_P)); | |
4321 int selected_p = !NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_SELECTED_P)); | |
4322 int idx; | |
4323 int img_id; | |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4324 int icon_size = 0; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4325 struct image *img = NULL; |
49323 | 4326 Lisp_Object image; |
100100
f5d2a2e44839
(update_frame_tool_bar): Initialize variable.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
98555
diff
changeset
|
4327 Lisp_Object stock = Qnil; |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4328 GtkStockItem stock_item; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4329 char *stock_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4330 char *icon_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4331 Lisp_Object rtl; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4332 GtkWidget *wbutton = NULL; |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4333 GtkWidget *weventbox; |
79460
1d493051aed3
(update_frame_tool_bar): Don't call x-gtk-map-stock if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
79340
diff
changeset
|
4334 Lisp_Object specified_file; |
109826
deed7c075550
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Literal stings are const char*.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109821
diff
changeset
|
4335 const char *label = (STRINGP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_LABEL)) |
deed7c075550
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Literal stings are const char*.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109821
diff
changeset
|
4336 ? SSDATA (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_LABEL)) : ""); |
111650
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4337 int vert_only = ! NILP (PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_VERT_ONLY)); |
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4338 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4339 ti = gtk_toolbar_get_nth_item (GTK_TOOLBAR (wtoolbar), i); |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4340 |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4341 if (ti) |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4342 { |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4343 weventbox = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (ti)); |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4344 wbutton = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (weventbox)); |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4345 } |
49323 | 4346 |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4347 |
49323 | 4348 image = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_IMAGES); |
4349 | |
4350 /* Ignore invalid image specifications. */ | |
4351 if (!valid_image_p (image)) | |
4352 { | |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4353 if (wbutton) gtk_widget_hide (wbutton); |
49323 | 4354 continue; |
4355 } | |
4356 | |
79460
1d493051aed3
(update_frame_tool_bar): Don't call x-gtk-map-stock if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
79340
diff
changeset
|
4357 specified_file = file_for_image (image); |
103916
9653887b5cd0
* xterm.c (Qx_gtk_map_stock): New var.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103690
diff
changeset
|
4358 if (!NILP (specified_file) && !NILP (Ffboundp (Qx_gtk_map_stock))) |
9653887b5cd0
* xterm.c (Qx_gtk_map_stock): New var.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103690
diff
changeset
|
4359 stock = call1 (Qx_gtk_map_stock, specified_file); |
9653887b5cd0
* xterm.c (Qx_gtk_map_stock): New var.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103690
diff
changeset
|
4360 |
9653887b5cd0
* xterm.c (Qx_gtk_map_stock): New var.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
103690
diff
changeset
|
4361 if (STRINGP (stock)) |
49468
f2be5cd8262f
gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Call prepare_image_for_display
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49434
diff
changeset
|
4362 { |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4363 stock_name = SSDATA (stock); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4364 if (stock_name[0] == 'n' && stock_name[1] == ':') |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4365 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4366 GdkScreen *screen = gtk_widget_get_screen (GTK_WIDGET (wtoolbar)); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4367 GtkIconTheme *icon_theme = gtk_icon_theme_get_for_screen (screen); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4368 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4369 icon_name = stock_name + 2; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4370 stock_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4371 stock = Qnil; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4372 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4373 if (! gtk_icon_theme_has_icon (icon_theme, icon_name)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4374 icon_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4375 else |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4376 icon_size = gtk_toolbar_get_icon_size (wtoolbar); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4377 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4378 else if (gtk_stock_lookup (SSDATA (stock), &stock_item)) |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4379 icon_size = gtk_toolbar_get_icon_size (wtoolbar); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
4380 else |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4381 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4382 stock = Qnil; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4383 stock_name = NULL; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4384 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4385 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4386 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4387 if (stock_name == NULL && icon_name == NULL) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4388 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4389 /* No stock image, or stock item not known. Try regular image. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4390 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4391 /* If image is a vector, choose the image according to the |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4392 button state. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4393 if (dir == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4394 && !NILP (rtl = PROP (TOOL_BAR_ITEM_RTL_IMAGE)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4395 && STRINGP (rtl)) |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4396 { |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4397 image = find_rtl_image (f, image, rtl); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4398 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4399 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4400 if (VECTORP (image)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4401 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4402 if (enabled_p) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4403 idx = (selected_p |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4404 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_SELECTED |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4405 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_ENABLED_DESELECTED); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4406 else |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4407 idx = (selected_p |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4408 ? TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_SELECTED |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4409 : TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DISABLED_DESELECTED); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4410 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4411 xassert (ASIZE (image) >= idx); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4412 image = AREF (image, idx); |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4413 } |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4414 else |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4415 idx = -1; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4416 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4417 img_id = lookup_image (f, image); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4418 img = IMAGE_FROM_ID (f, img_id); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4419 prepare_image_for_display (f, img); |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
4420 |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4421 if (img->load_failed_p || img->pixmap == None) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4422 { |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4423 if (ti) |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4424 gtk_widget_hide_all (GTK_WIDGET (ti)); |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4425 else |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4426 { |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4427 /* Insert an empty (non-image) button */ |
111650
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4428 ti = xg_make_tool_item (f, NULL, NULL, "", i, 0); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4429 gtk_toolbar_insert (GTK_TOOLBAR (wtoolbar), ti, -1); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4430 } |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4431 continue; |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4432 } |
49468
f2be5cd8262f
gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Call prepare_image_for_display
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49434
diff
changeset
|
4433 } |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
4434 |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4435 if (ti == NULL) |
49323 | 4436 { |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4437 GtkWidget *w; |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4438 if (stock_name) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4439 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4440 w = gtk_image_new_from_stock (stock_name, icon_size); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4441 g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (w), XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4442 (gpointer) xstrdup (stock_name), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4443 (GDestroyNotify) xfree); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4444 } |
102283
43221c2f4272
Fix typo in comment.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
100951
diff
changeset
|
4445 else if (icon_name) |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4446 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4447 w = gtk_image_new_from_icon_name (icon_name, icon_size); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4448 g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (w), XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4449 (gpointer) xstrdup (icon_name), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4450 (GDestroyNotify) xfree); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4451 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4452 else |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4453 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4454 w = xg_get_image_for_pixmap (f, img, x->widget, NULL); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4455 /* Save the image so we can see if an update is needed when |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4456 this function is called again. */ |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4457 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (w), XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4458 (gpointer)img->pixmap); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4459 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4460 |
59084
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4461 gtk_misc_set_padding (GTK_MISC (w), hmargin, vmargin); |
111650
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4462 ti = xg_make_tool_item (f, w, &wbutton, label, i, vert_only); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4463 gtk_toolbar_insert (GTK_TOOLBAR (wtoolbar), ti, -1); |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4464 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (wbutton, enabled_p); |
49323 | 4465 } |
4466 else | |
4467 { | |
109067
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4468 GtkWidget *vb = gtk_bin_get_child (GTK_BIN (wbutton)); |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4469 GtkWidget *wimage; |
b5f73bf59a4f
Use non-deprecated Gtk+ functions, add changes for Gtk+3 with GSEAL_ENABLE.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109040
diff
changeset
|
4470 GtkWidget *wlbl = xg_get_tool_bar_widgets (vb, &wimage); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4471 |
50059
ffb4a4dbe4c0
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Compare pixmap ID instead of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49826
diff
changeset
|
4472 Pixmap old_img = (Pixmap)g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), |
ffb4a4dbe4c0
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Compare pixmap ID instead of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49826
diff
changeset
|
4473 XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4474 gpointer old_stock_name = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4475 XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4476 gpointer old_icon_name = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4477 XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4478 gtk_label_set_text (GTK_LABEL (wlbl), label); |
111650
8fd0d7bcdf7d
Add keyword :vert-only for tool bar items with labels not shown horizontally.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
111186
diff
changeset
|
4479 gtk_tool_item_set_is_important (ti, !vert_only); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4480 if (stock_name && |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4481 (! old_stock_name || strcmp (old_stock_name, stock_name) != 0)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4482 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4483 gtk_image_set_from_stock (GTK_IMAGE (wimage), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4484 stock_name, icon_size); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4485 g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4486 (gpointer) xstrdup (stock_name), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4487 (GDestroyNotify) xfree); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4488 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4489 NULL); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4490 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4491 NULL); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4492 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4493 else if (icon_name && |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4494 (! old_icon_name || strcmp (old_icon_name, icon_name) != 0)) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4495 { |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4496 gtk_image_set_from_icon_name (GTK_IMAGE (wimage), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4497 icon_name, icon_size); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4498 g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4499 (gpointer) xstrdup (icon_name), |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4500 (GDestroyNotify) xfree); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4501 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4502 NULL); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4503 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4504 NULL); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4505 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4506 else if (img && old_img != img->pixmap) |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4507 { |
109141
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
4508 (void) xg_get_image_for_pixmap (f, img, x->widget, |
fa173b9bd9ce
Fix some bad prototypes and formatting after conversion from K&R declaration.
Jan D <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109139
diff
changeset
|
4509 GTK_IMAGE (wimage)); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4510 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_IMAGE_DATA, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4511 (gpointer)img->pixmap); |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4512 |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4513 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_STOCK_NAME, |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4514 NULL); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4515 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (wimage), XG_TOOL_BAR_ICON_NAME, |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4516 NULL); |
78721
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4517 } |
a888c5a82ba5
(file_for_image, find_rtl_image): New functions.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
78690
diff
changeset
|
4518 |
59084
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4519 gtk_misc_set_padding (GTK_MISC (wimage), hmargin, vmargin); |
6a0b8f23858b
* gtkutil.c (update_frame_tool_bar): Make the value of
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
58818
diff
changeset
|
4520 |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4521 gtk_widget_set_sensitive (wbutton, enabled_p); |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4522 } |
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4523 xg_show_toolbar_item (ti); |
49600
23a1cea22d13
Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents:
49572
diff
changeset
|
4524 |
49323 | 4525 #undef PROP |
4526 } | |
4527 | |
4528 /* Remove buttons not longer needed. We just hide them so they | |
4529 can be reused later on. */ | |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4530 do |
49323 | 4531 { |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4532 ti = gtk_toolbar_get_nth_item (GTK_TOOLBAR (wtoolbar), i++); |
74990
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4533 if (ti) gtk_widget_hide_all (GTK_WIDGET (ti)); |
de706755c4d7
(xg_tool_bar_button_cb): Save last modifier on widget.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
74376
diff
changeset
|
4534 } while (ti != NULL); |
49323 | 4535 |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4536 if (f->n_tool_bar_items != 0) |
49323 | 4537 { |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4538 if (pack_tool_bar) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4539 xg_pack_tool_bar (f, f->tool_bar_position); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4540 gtk_widget_show (x->toolbar_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4541 gtk_widget_show (x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4542 if (xg_update_tool_bar_sizes (f)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4543 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
49323 | 4544 } |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4545 |
49323 | 4546 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
4547 } | |
4548 | |
57715
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4549 /* Deallocate all resources for the tool bar on frame F. |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4550 Remove the tool bar. */ |
cdc48cdd5b0e
* gtkutil.c: Put empty line between comment and function body.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
57597
diff
changeset
|
4551 |
49323 | 4552 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4553 free_frame_tool_bar (FRAME_PTR f) |
49323 | 4554 { |
4555 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; | |
4556 | |
4557 if (x->toolbar_widget) | |
4558 { | |
93030
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4559 int is_packed = x->handlebox_widget != 0; |
49323 | 4560 BLOCK_INPUT; |
93030
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4561 /* We may have created the toolbar_widget in xg_create_tool_bar, but |
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4562 not the x->handlebox_widget which is created in xg_pack_tool_bar. */ |
111781
0bd93f14fcb6
Fix error in last merge.
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents:
111779
diff
changeset
|
4563 if (is_packed) |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4564 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4565 if (x->toolbar_in_hbox) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4566 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->hbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4567 x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4568 else |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4569 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->vbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4570 x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4571 } |
93030
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4572 else |
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4573 gtk_widget_destroy (x->toolbar_widget); |
d38f7962c052
(free_frame_tool_bar): Only call gtk_container_remove if
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
92366
diff
changeset
|
4574 |
49323 | 4575 x->toolbar_widget = 0; |
4576 x->handlebox_widget = 0; | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4577 FRAME_TOOLBAR_TOP_HEIGHT (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_BOTTOM_HEIGHT (f) = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4578 FRAME_TOOLBAR_LEFT_WIDTH (f) = FRAME_TOOLBAR_RIGHT_WIDTH (f) = 0; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4579 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4580 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
103665
340c701162a6
* emacs.c (USAGE3, standard_args): Add -mm and --maximized.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
103198
diff
changeset
|
4581 |
49323 | 4582 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
4583 } | |
4584 } | |
4585 | |
109581
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4586 int |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4587 xg_change_toolbar_position (FRAME_PTR f, Lisp_Object pos) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4588 { |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4589 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4590 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4591 if (! x->toolbar_widget || ! x->handlebox_widget) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4592 return 1; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4593 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4594 BLOCK_INPUT; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4595 g_object_ref (x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4596 if (x->toolbar_in_hbox) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4597 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->hbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4598 x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4599 else |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4600 gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (x->vbox_widget), |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4601 x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4602 xg_pack_tool_bar (f, pos); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4603 g_object_unref (x->handlebox_widget); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4604 if (xg_update_tool_bar_sizes (f)) |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4605 xg_height_or_width_changed (f); |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4606 |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4607 UNBLOCK_INPUT; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4608 return 1; |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4609 } |
06384b3caebf
Add ability to put Gtk+ tool bar on the left/right/bottom or top. Default top.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
109566
diff
changeset
|
4610 |
49323 | 4611 |
4612 | |
4613 /*********************************************************************** | |
4614 Initializing | |
108024
4d8277a44bb4
Gtk tool bars can be text, icons with text or just icons.
Jan D. <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
107997
diff
changeset
|
4615 ***********************************************************************/ |
49323 | 4616 void |
109126
aec1143e8d85
Convert (most) functions in src to standard C.
Dan Nicolaescu <dann@ics.uci.edu>
parents:
109100
diff
changeset
|
4617 xg_initialize (void) |
49323 | 4618 { |
59102
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4619 GtkBindingSet *binding_set; |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4620 |
75417
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4621 #if HAVE_XFT |
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4622 /* Work around a bug with corrupted data if libXft gets unloaded. This way |
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4623 we keep it permanently linked in. */ |
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4624 XftInit (0); |
c21d47d727f3
(xg_initialize): Call XftInit if HAVE_XFT.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
75348
diff
changeset
|
4625 #endif |
84621 | 4626 |
4627 gdpy_def = NULL; | |
49323 | 4628 xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar = 0; |
52981
54482f5ea7be
Remove tear off capability for GTK popup menus.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
52401
diff
changeset
|
4629 xg_detached_menus = 0; |
49323 | 4630 xg_menu_cb_list.prev = xg_menu_cb_list.next = |
4631 xg_menu_item_cb_list.prev = xg_menu_item_cb_list.next = 0; | |
4632 | |
49419
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4633 id_to_widget.max_size = id_to_widget.used = 0; |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4634 id_to_widget.widgets = 0; |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4635 |
49323 | 4636 /* Remove F10 as a menu accelerator, it does not mix well with Emacs key |
4637 bindings. It doesn't seem to be any way to remove properties, | |
4638 so we set it to VoidSymbol which in X means "no key". */ | |
4639 gtk_settings_set_string_property (gtk_settings_get_default (), | |
4640 "gtk-menu-bar-accel", | |
4641 "VoidSymbol", | |
4642 EMACS_CLASS); | |
49419
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4643 |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4644 /* Make GTK text input widgets use Emacs style keybindings. This is |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4645 Emacs after all. */ |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4646 gtk_settings_set_string_property (gtk_settings_get_default (), |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4647 "gtk-key-theme-name", |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4648 "Emacs", |
6562bb5f04aa
gtkutil.c (xg_initialize): Initialize id_to_widget here instead
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
49359
diff
changeset
|
4649 EMACS_CLASS); |
59102
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4650 |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4651 /* Make dialogs close on C-g. Since file dialog inherits from |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4652 dialog, this works for them also. */ |
103022
15bf0d8a6099
Make Emacs compile when Gtk+ and -DGTK_DISABLE_DEPRECATED is used.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102705
diff
changeset
|
4653 binding_set = gtk_binding_set_by_class (g_type_class_ref (GTK_TYPE_DIALOG)); |
59102
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4654 gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_g, GDK_CONTROL_MASK, |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4655 "close", 0); |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4656 |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4657 /* Make menus close on C-g. */ |
103022
15bf0d8a6099
Make Emacs compile when Gtk+ and -DGTK_DISABLE_DEPRECATED is used.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102705
diff
changeset
|
4658 binding_set = gtk_binding_set_by_class (g_type_class_ref |
15bf0d8a6099
Make Emacs compile when Gtk+ and -DGTK_DISABLE_DEPRECATED is used.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
102705
diff
changeset
|
4659 (GTK_TYPE_MENU_SHELL)); |
59102
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4660 gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_g, GDK_CONTROL_MASK, |
0096c58ce34a
* xmenu.c (popup_get_selection): Pop down on C-g.
Jan Djärv <jan.h.d@swipnet.se>
parents:
59084
diff
changeset
|
4661 "cancel", 0); |
49323 | 4662 } |
4663 | |
4664 #endif /* USE_GTK */ | |
52401 | 4665 |
4666 /* arch-tag: fe7104da-bc1e-4aba-9bd1-f349c528f7e3 | |
4667 (do not change this comment) */ |